4 @setfilename ../../info/org
5 @settitle The Org Manual
10 @c Use proper quote and backtick for code sections in PDF output
11 @c Cf. Texinfo manual 14.2
12 @set txicodequoteundirected
13 @set txicodequotebacktick
15 @c Version and Contact Info
16 @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage}
17 @set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
18 @set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
19 @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
20 @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
25 @macro orgcmd{key,command}
29 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
34 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
44 @c @hyphenation{time-stamp time-stamps time-stamp-ing time-stamp-ed}
59 @c Subheadings inside a table.
60 @macro tsubheading{text}
70 This manual is for Org version @value{VERSION}.
72 Copyright @copyright{} 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
73 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
76 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
77 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
78 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
79 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
80 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
81 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
83 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
84 modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
85 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
87 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
88 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
89 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
90 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
96 * Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
100 @title The Org Manual
102 @subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
103 @author by Carsten Dominik
104 with contributions by David O'Toole, Bastien Guerry, Philip Rooke, Dan Davison, Eric Schulte, and Thomas Dye
106 @c The following two commands start the copyright page.
108 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
112 @c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
116 @node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
123 * Introduction:: Getting started
124 * Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
125 * Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
126 * Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
127 * TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
128 * Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
129 * Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
130 * Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
131 * Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects
132 * Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
133 * Markup:: Prepare text for rich export
134 * Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes
135 * Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
136 * Working With Source Code:: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks
137 * Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
138 * Hacking:: How to hack your way around
139 * MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device
140 * History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
141 * Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
142 * Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
143 * Command and Function Index:: Command names and some internal functions
144 * Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual
147 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
151 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
152 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
153 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
154 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
155 * Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
159 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
160 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
161 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
162 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
163 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
164 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
165 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
166 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
167 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
168 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
169 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
173 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
174 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
175 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
176 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
177 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
178 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
182 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
183 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
184 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
185 * Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
186 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
187 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
188 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
189 * Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
193 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
194 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
195 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
196 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
197 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
198 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
199 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
200 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
204 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
208 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
209 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
210 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
211 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
212 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
213 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
215 Extended use of TODO keywords
217 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
218 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
219 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
220 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
221 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
222 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
223 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
227 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
228 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
229 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
233 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
234 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
235 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
237 Properties and columns
239 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
240 * Special properties:: Access to other Org-mode features
241 * Property searches:: Matching property values
242 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
243 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
244 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
248 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
249 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
250 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
254 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
255 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
259 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
260 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
261 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
262 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
263 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time if you've been idle
264 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
265 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
269 * The date/time prompt:: How Org-mode helps you entering date and time
270 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
272 Deadlines and scheduling
274 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
275 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
277 Capture - Refile - Archive
279 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
280 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
281 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
282 * Protocols:: External (e.g. Browser) access to Emacs and Org
283 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
284 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
288 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
289 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
290 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
294 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
295 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
299 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
300 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
304 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
305 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
306 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
307 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
308 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
309 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
310 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
311 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
313 The built-in agenda views
315 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
316 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
317 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
318 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
319 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
320 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
322 Presentation and sorting
324 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
325 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
326 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
330 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
331 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
332 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
334 Markup for rich export
336 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
337 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
338 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
339 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
340 * Index entries:: Making an index
341 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
342 * Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
344 Structural markup elements
346 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
347 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
348 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
349 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
351 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
352 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
353 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
354 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
355 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
359 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
360 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
361 * LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
362 * Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
363 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
367 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
368 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
369 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
370 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
371 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
372 * LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to La@TeX{}, and processing to PDF
373 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
374 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
375 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
376 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
377 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
381 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
382 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org-mode
383 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
384 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
385 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
386 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
387 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
388 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
389 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
391 La@TeX{} and PDF export
393 * LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invokes which commands
394 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
395 * Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal La@TeX{} code
396 * Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to La@TeX{}
397 * Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into La@TeX{} output
398 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
402 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
403 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
404 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
405 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
406 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
407 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
411 * Configuration:: Defining projects
412 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
413 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
414 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
418 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
419 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
420 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
421 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
422 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
423 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
424 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
425 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
429 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
430 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
432 Working with source code
434 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
435 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
436 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
437 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
438 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org-mode buffer
439 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
440 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
441 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
442 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
443 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org-mode
444 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
445 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
449 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
450 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
452 Using header arguments
454 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
455 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
456 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
457 * Header arguments in Org-mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
458 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
460 Specific header arguments
462 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
463 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
464 be collected and handled
465 * file:: Specify a path for file output
466 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
467 directory for code block execution
468 * exports:: Export code and/or results
469 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
470 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
472 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
473 expansion during tangling
474 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
475 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
476 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
477 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
478 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
479 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
480 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
481 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
485 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
486 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
487 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
488 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
489 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
490 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
491 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
492 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
493 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
494 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
496 Interaction with other packages
498 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
499 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
503 * Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
504 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
505 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
506 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
507 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for La@TeX{} and other programs
508 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
509 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
510 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
511 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
512 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
514 Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
516 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
517 * A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
518 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
519 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
523 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
524 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
525 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
530 @node Introduction, Document Structure, Top, Top
531 @chapter Introduction
535 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
536 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
537 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
538 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
539 * Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
542 @node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction
546 Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
547 project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
549 Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
550 lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is
551 implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the
552 content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and
553 structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created
554 with a built-in table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines,
555 timestamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an
556 agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar
557 and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails,
558 Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
559 For printing and sharing of notes, an Org file can be exported as a
560 structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an
561 iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of
564 As a project planning environment, Org works by adding metadata to outline
565 nodes. Based on this data, specific entries can be extracted in queries and
566 create dynamic @i{agenda views}.
568 Org mode contains the Org Babel environment which allows to work with
569 embedded source code block in a file, to facilitate code evaluation,
570 documentation, and tangling.
572 Org's automatic, context-sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
573 capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
574 minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
575 tables in arbitrary file types, for example in La@TeX{}. The structure
576 editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with
577 the minor Orgstruct mode.
579 Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should
580 feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
581 imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
582 it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways and for different
586 @r{@bullet{} an outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing}
587 @r{@bullet{} an ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes}
588 @r{@bullet{} a TODO list editor}
589 @r{@bullet{} a full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling}
590 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
591 @r{@bullet{} an environment in which to implement David Allen's GTD system}
592 @r{@bullet{} a simple hypertext system, with HTML and La@TeX{} export}
593 @r{@bullet{} a publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages}
594 @r{@bullet{} an environment for literate programming}
599 There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
600 version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
601 questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc@. This page is located at
602 @uref{http://orgmode.org}.
607 @node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction
608 @section Installation
612 @b{Important:} @i{If you are using a version of Org that is part of the Emacs
613 distribution or an XEmacs package, please skip this section and go directly
614 to @ref{Activation}.}
616 If you have downloaded Org from the Web, either as a distribution @file{.zip}
617 or @file{.tar} file, or as a Git archive, you must take the following steps
618 to install it: go into the unpacked Org distribution directory and edit the
619 top section of the file @file{Makefile}. You must set the name of the Emacs
620 binary (likely either @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths to the
621 directories where local Lisp and Info files are kept. If you don't have
622 access to the system-wide directories, you can simply run Org directly from
623 the distribution directory by adding the @file{lisp} subdirectory to the
624 Emacs load path. To do this, add the following line to @file{.emacs}:
627 (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp" load-path))
631 If you plan to use code from the @file{contrib} subdirectory, do a similar
632 step for this directory:
635 (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" load-path))
638 @noindent Now byte-compile the Lisp files with the shell command:
644 @noindent If you are running Org from the distribution directory, this is
645 all. If you want to install Org into the system directories, use (as
652 Installing Info files is system dependent, because of differences in the
653 @file{install-info} program. In Debian it copies the info files into the
654 correct directory and modifies the info directory file. In many other
655 systems, the files need to be copied to the correct directory separately, and
656 @file{install-info} then only modifies the directory file. Check your system
657 documentation to find out which of the following commands you need:
661 make install-info-debian
664 Then add the following line to @file{.emacs}. It is needed so that
665 Emacs can autoload functions that are located in files not immediately loaded
666 when Org-mode starts.
668 (require 'org-install)
671 Do not forget to activate Org as described in the following section.
674 @node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction
678 @cindex global key bindings
679 @cindex key bindings, global
681 Add the following lines to your @file{.emacs} file. The last three lines
682 define @emph{global} keys for the commands @command{org-store-link},
683 @command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb}---please choose suitable
687 ;; The following lines are always needed. Choose your own keys.
688 (add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
689 (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
690 (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
691 (global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
694 Furthermore, you must activate @code{font-lock-mode} in Org
695 buffers, because significant functionality depends on font-locking being
696 active. You can do this with either one of the following two lines
697 (XEmacs users must use the second option):
699 (global-font-lock-mode 1) ; for all buffers
700 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock) ; Org buffers only
703 @cindex Org-mode, turning on
704 With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put
705 into Org-mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look
709 MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
712 @vindex org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file
713 @noindent which will select Org-mode for this buffer no matter what
714 the file's name is. See also the variable
715 @code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
717 Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is @i{active}. To make
718 use of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode}
719 (@code{zmacs-regions} in XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default,
720 in Emacs 22 you need to do this yourself with
722 (transient-mark-mode 1)
724 @noindent If you do not like @code{transient-mark-mode}, you can create an
725 active region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing
726 @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} twice before moving the cursor.
728 @node Feedback, Conventions, Activation, Introduction
735 If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
736 about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
737 If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the
738 list after a moderator has approved it@footnote{Please consider subscribing
739 to the mailing list, in order to minimize the work the mailing list
740 moderators have to do.}.
742 For bug reports, please first try to reproduce the bug with the latest
743 version of Org available - if you are running an outdated version, it is
744 quite possible that the bug has been fixed already. If the bug persists,
745 prepare a report and provide as much information as possible, including the
746 version information of Emacs (@kbd{M-x emacs-version @key{RET}}) and Org
747 (@kbd{M-x org-version @key{RET}}), as well as the Org related setup in
748 @file{.emacs}. The easiest way to do this is to use the command
750 @kbd{M-x org-submit-bug-report}
752 @noindent which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so
753 that you only need to add your description. If you re not sending the Email
754 from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email program.
756 If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to
757 create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear information
761 @item What exactly did you do?
762 @item What did you expect to happen?
763 @item What happened instead?
765 @noindent Thank you for helping to improve this program.
767 @subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
769 @cindex backtrace of an error
770 If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
771 understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
772 providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{backtrace}.
773 This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
774 error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
778 Reload uncompiled versions of all Org-mode Lisp files. The backtrace
779 contains much more information if it is produced with uncompiled code.
782 C-u M-x org-reload RET
785 or select @code{Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled} from the
788 Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}
789 (XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu).
791 Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
792 document the steps you take.
794 When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
795 screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
796 attach it to your bug report.
799 @node Conventions, , Feedback, Introduction
800 @section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
802 Org uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags, and property
803 names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
808 TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
812 User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
813 meaning are written with all capitals.
816 User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
817 special meaning are written with all capitals.
820 @node Document Structure, Tables, Introduction, Top
821 @chapter Document structure
822 @cindex document structure
823 @cindex structure of document
825 Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to
826 edit the structure of the document.
829 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
830 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
831 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
832 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
833 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
834 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
835 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
836 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
837 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
838 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
839 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
842 @node Outlines, Headlines, Document Structure, Document Structure
847 Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
848 document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
849 for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
850 of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
851 document to show only the general document structure and the parts
852 currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
853 outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
854 command, @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
856 @node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document Structure
860 @vindex org-special-ctrl-a/e
861 @vindex org-special-ctrl-k
862 @vindex org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree
864 Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in Org
865 start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See the variables
866 @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e}, @code{org-special-ctrl-k}, and
867 @code{org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree} to configure special behavior of @kbd{C-a},
868 @kbd{C-e}, and @kbd{C-k} in headlines.}. For example:
878 * Another top level headline
881 @noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
882 outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
883 starters. @ref{Clean view}, describes a setup to realize this.
885 @vindex org-cycle-separator-lines
886 An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
887 will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
888 least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
889 the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
890 variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
892 @node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document Structure
893 @section Visibility cycling
894 @cindex cycling, visibility
895 @cindex visibility cycling
896 @cindex trees, visibility
897 @cindex show hidden text
900 Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
901 Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
902 @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
904 @cindex subtree visibility states
905 @cindex subtree cycling
906 @cindex folded, subtree visibility state
907 @cindex children, subtree visibility state
908 @cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
910 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
911 @emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
914 ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
915 '-----------------------------------'
918 @vindex org-cycle-emulate-tab
919 @vindex org-cycle-global-at-bob
920 The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
921 the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
922 beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
923 @key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
924 option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
925 argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
927 @cindex global visibility states
928 @cindex global cycling
929 @cindex overview, global visibility state
930 @cindex contents, global visibility state
931 @cindex show all, global visibility state
932 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-global-cycle}
934 @emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
937 ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
938 '--------------------------------------'
941 When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
942 CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
943 tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
945 @cindex show all, command
946 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB},show-all}
947 Show all, including drawers.
948 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-reveal}
949 Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
950 and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
951 exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
952 (@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
953 level, all sibling headings. With double prefix arg, also show the entire
954 subtree of the parent.
955 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,show-branches}
956 Expose all the headings of the subtree, CONTENT view for just one subtree.
957 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
958 Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect
961 (@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual})
964 (see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers)
966 will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current
967 tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer,
968 but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With a numeric
969 prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
970 negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove
971 the previously used indirect buffer.
974 @vindex org-startup-folded
975 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
976 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
977 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
978 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
980 When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
981 OVERVIEW, i.e. only the top level headlines are visible. This can be
982 configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a
983 per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the
990 #+STARTUP: showeverything
993 @cindex property, VISIBILITY
995 Furthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
996 and Columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
997 for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
1000 @orgcmd{C-u C-u @key{TAB},org-set-startup-visibility}
1001 Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e. whatever is
1002 requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
1006 @node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document Structure
1008 @cindex motion, between headlines
1009 @cindex jumping, to headlines
1010 @cindex headline navigation
1011 The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
1014 @orgcmd{C-c C-n,outline-next-visible-heading}
1016 @orgcmd{C-c C-p,outline-previous-visible-heading}
1018 @orgcmd{C-c C-f,org-forward-same-level}
1019 Next heading same level.
1020 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-backward-same-level}
1021 Previous heading same level.
1022 @orgcmd{C-c C-u,outline-up-heading}
1023 Backward to higher level heading.
1024 @orgcmd{C-c C-j,org-goto}
1025 Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
1026 visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
1027 you can use the following keys to find your destination:
1028 @vindex org-goto-auto-isearch
1030 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
1031 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1032 @key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
1033 @kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
1034 @r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
1035 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1036 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
1038 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
1041 @vindex org-goto-interface
1043 See also the variable @code{org-goto-interface}.
1046 @node Structure editing, Sparse trees, Motion, Document Structure
1047 @section Structure editing
1048 @cindex structure editing
1049 @cindex headline, promotion and demotion
1050 @cindex promotion, of subtrees
1051 @cindex demotion, of subtrees
1052 @cindex subtree, cut and paste
1053 @cindex pasting, of subtrees
1054 @cindex cutting, of subtrees
1055 @cindex copying, of subtrees
1056 @cindex sorting, of subtrees
1057 @cindex subtrees, cut and paste
1060 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1061 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1062 Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is in a
1063 plain list item, a new item is created (@pxref{Plain lists}). To force
1064 creation of a new headline, use a prefix argument, or first press @key{RET}
1065 to get to the beginning of the next line. When this command is used in
1066 the middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes
1067 the new headline@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split,
1068 customize the variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If the
1069 command is used at the beginning of a headline, the new headline is
1070 created before the current line. If at the beginning of any other line,
1071 the content of that line is made the new heading. If the command is
1072 used at the end of a folded subtree (i.e. behind the ellipses at the end
1073 of a headline), then a headline like the current one will be inserted
1074 after the end of the subtree.
1077 Just like @kbd{M-@key{RET}}, except when adding a new heading below the
1078 current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead of before
1079 it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
1080 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1082 @vindex org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change
1083 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See also the
1084 variable @code{org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change}.
1085 @kindex C-S-@key{RET}
1087 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
1088 @kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
1090 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1091 In a new entry with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the entry to
1092 become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1093 and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you are back
1094 to the initial level.
1095 @orgcmd{M-@key{left},org-do-promote}
1096 Promote current heading by one level.
1097 @orgcmd{M-@key{right},org-do-demote}
1098 Demote current heading by one level.
1099 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-promote-subtree}
1100 Promote the current subtree by one level.
1101 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-demote-subtree}
1102 Demote the current subtree by one level.
1103 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-move-subtree-up}
1104 Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
1106 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-move-subtree-down}
1107 Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
1108 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-cut-subtree}
1109 Kill subtree, i.e. remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
1110 With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
1111 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-copy-subtree}
1112 Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
1113 sequential subtrees.
1114 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-paste-subtree}
1115 Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
1116 make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
1117 also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
1118 headline marker like @samp{****}.
1119 @orgcmd{C-y,org-yank}
1120 @vindex org-yank-adjusted-subtrees
1121 @vindex org-yank-folded-subtrees
1122 Depending on the variables @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
1123 @code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
1124 paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
1125 C-x C-y}. With the default settings, no level adjustment will take place,
1126 but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing so would swallow text
1127 previously visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal
1128 @code{yank} to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to
1129 force a normal yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a
1130 yank, it will yank previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and
1132 @orgcmd{C-c C-x c,org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}
1133 Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You will be
1134 prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also specify if any
1135 timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This can be useful, for example,
1136 to create a number of tasks related to a series of lectures to prepare. For
1137 more details, see the docstring of the command
1138 @code{org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}.
1139 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
1140 Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refiling notes}.
1141 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-sort-entries-or-items}
1142 Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
1143 region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
1144 sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
1145 alphabetically, numerically, by time (first timestamp with active preferred,
1146 creation time, scheduled time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword
1147 (in the sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the value
1148 of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also supply
1149 your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
1150 sorting will be case-sensitive. With two @kbd{C-u C-u} prefixes, duplicate
1151 entries will also be removed.
1152 @orgcmd{C-x n s,org-narrow-to-subtree}
1153 Narrow buffer to current subtree.
1154 @orgcmd{C-x n w,widen}
1155 Widen buffer to remove narrowing.
1156 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-toggle-heading}
1157 Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a
1158 subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a normal line by
1159 removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the
1160 region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn
1161 only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a
1162 headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
1165 @cindex region, active
1166 @cindex active region
1167 @cindex transient mark mode
1168 When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and
1169 demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
1170 headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
1171 line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
1172 just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
1173 inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
1177 @node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Structure editing, Document Structure
1178 @section Sparse trees
1179 @cindex sparse trees
1180 @cindex trees, sparse
1181 @cindex folding, sparse trees
1182 @cindex occur, command
1184 @vindex org-show-hierarchy-above
1185 @vindex org-show-following-heading
1186 @vindex org-show-siblings
1187 @vindex org-show-entry-below
1188 An important feature of Org-mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
1189 trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
1190 document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
1191 visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
1192 variables @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading},
1193 @code{org-show-siblings}, and @code{org-show-entry-below} for detailed
1194 control on how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out
1195 and you will see immediately how it works.
1197 Org-mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
1198 commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
1201 @orgcmd{C-c /,org-sparse-tree}
1202 This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
1205 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
1206 Occur. Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
1207 the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
1208 the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
1209 provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
1210 is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
1211 highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
1212 editing command@footnote{This depends on the option
1213 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
1214 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
1215 so several calls to this command can be stacked.
1219 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
1220 For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
1221 use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
1222 keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
1223 accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
1227 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
1228 '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
1231 @noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
1232 a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
1234 The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
1235 tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
1238 @cindex printing sparse trees
1239 @cindex visible text, printing
1240 To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
1241 @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts
1242 of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because
1243 XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}.
1244 Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e v} to export only the visible
1245 part of the document and print the resulting file.
1247 @node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document Structure
1248 @section Plain lists
1250 @cindex lists, plain
1251 @cindex lists, ordered
1252 @cindex ordered lists
1254 Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
1255 additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of
1256 checkboxes (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists,
1257 and the HTML exporter (@pxref{Exporting}) parses and formats them.
1259 Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
1262 @emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
1263 @samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
1264 they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
1265 stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star are
1266 visually indistinguishable from true headlines. In short: even though
1267 @samp{*} is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.}
1270 @emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
1271 a right parenthesis, such as @samp{1.} or @samp{1)}. If you want a list to
1272 start a different value (e.g. 20), start the text of the item with
1273 @code{[@@start:20]}.
1275 @emph{Description} list items are unordered list items, and contain the
1276 separator @samp{ :: } to separate the description @emph{term} from the
1280 @vindex org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists
1281 Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
1282 line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
1283 2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
1284 list. Indentation also determines the end of a list item. It ends before
1285 the next line that is indented like the bullet/number, or less. Empty lines
1286 are part of the previous item, so you can have several paragraphs in one
1287 item. If you would like an empty line to terminate all currently open plain
1288 lists, configure the variable @code{org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.
1293 ** Lord of the Rings
1294 My favorite scenes are (in this order)
1295 1. The attack of the Rohirrim
1296 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
1297 + this was already my favorite scene in the book
1298 + I really like Miranda Otto.
1299 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
1301 He makes a really funny face when it happens.
1302 But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
1303 Important actors in this film are:
1304 - @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays Frodo
1305 - @b{Sean Austin} :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember
1306 him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in @i{The Goonies}.
1310 Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to deal with
1311 them correctly@footnote{Org only changes the filling settings for Emacs. For
1312 XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones' @file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on,
1313 put into @file{.emacs}: @code{(require 'filladapt)}}, and by exporting them
1314 properly (@pxref{Exporting}). Since indentation is what governs the
1315 structure of these lists, many structural constructs like @code{#+BEGIN_...}
1316 blocks can be indented to signal that they should be part of a list item.
1318 @vindex org-list-demote-modify-bullet
1319 If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list (than that used for
1320 the current list-level) improves readability, customize the variable
1321 @code{org-list-demote-modify-bullet}.
1323 The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line
1324 of an item (the line with the bullet or number).
1327 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1328 @vindex org-cycle-include-plain-lists
1329 Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this works only if
1330 the cursor is on a plain list item. For more details, see the variable
1331 @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. to @code{integrate}, plain list items
1332 will be treated like low-level. The level of an item is then given by the
1333 indentation of the bullet/number. Items are always subordinate to real
1334 headlines, however; the hierarchies remain completely separated.
1336 If @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists} has not been set, @key{TAB}
1337 fixes the indentation of the current line in a heuristic way.
1338 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1339 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1340 Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
1341 heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
1342 of a line, the line is @emph{split} and the rest of the line becomes the new
1343 item@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split, customize the variable
1344 @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed in the
1345 @emph{whitespace before a bullet or number}, the new item is created
1346 @emph{before} the current item. If the command is executed in the white
1347 space before the text that is part of an item but does not contain the
1348 bullet, a bullet is added to the current line.
1349 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1351 Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
1352 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1353 In a new item with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the item to
1354 become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1355 and so on, all the way to the left margin. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you
1356 are back to the initial level.
1357 @kindex S-@key{down}
1360 @cindex shift-selection-mode
1361 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1362 Jump to the previous/next item in the current list, but only if
1363 @code{org-support-shift-select} is off. If not, you can still use paragraph
1364 jumping commands like @kbd{C-@key{up}} and @kbd{C-@key{down}} to quite
1366 @kindex M-S-@key{up}
1367 @kindex M-S-@key{down}
1369 @itemx M-S-@key{down}
1370 Move the item including subitems up/down (swap with previous/next item
1371 of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering is
1373 @kindex M-@key{left}
1374 @kindex M-@key{right}
1376 @itemx M-@key{right}
1377 Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children alone.
1378 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1379 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1380 @item M-S-@key{left}
1381 @itemx M-S-@key{right}
1382 Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
1383 Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation.
1384 When these commands are executed several times in direct succession,
1385 the initially selected region is used, even if the new indentation
1386 would imply a different hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break
1387 the command chain with a cursor motion or so.
1390 If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
1391 state of the checkbox. If not, this command makes sure that all the
1392 items on this list level use the same bullet. Furthermore, if this is
1393 an ordered list, make sure the numbering is OK.
1396 Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
1397 (@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}). With a numeric prefix
1398 argument N, select the Nth bullet from this list. If there is an active
1399 region when calling this, all lines will be converted to list items. If the
1400 first line already was a list item, any item markers will be removed from the
1401 list. Finally, even without an active region, a normal line will be
1402 converted into a list item.
1405 Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a subheading at
1406 its location). @xref{Structure editing}, for a detailed explanation.
1407 @kindex S-@key{left}
1408 @kindex S-@key{right}
1409 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
1410 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1411 This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the bullet or
1412 anywhere in an item line, details depending on
1413 @code{org-support-shift-select}.
1416 Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method:
1417 numerically, alphabetically, by time, or by custom function.
1420 @node Drawers, Blocks, Plain lists, Document Structure
1424 @cindex visibility cycling, drawers
1427 Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
1428 normally don't want to see it. For this, Org-mode has @emph{drawers}.
1429 Drawers need to be configured with the variable
1430 @code{org-drawers}@footnote{You can define drawers on a per-file basis
1431 with a line like @code{#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN PROPERTIES STATE}}. Drawers
1435 ** This is a headline
1436 Still outside the drawer
1438 This is inside the drawer.
1443 Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will hide and
1444 show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In order to
1445 look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the drawer line and
1446 press @key{TAB} there. Org-mode uses the @code{PROPERTIES} drawer for
1447 storing properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), and you can also arrange
1448 for state change notes (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}) and clock times
1449 (@pxref{Clocking work time}) to be stored in a drawer @code{LOGBOOK}. If you
1450 want to store a quick note in the LOGBOOK drawer, in a similar way as this is
1451 done by state changes, use
1456 Add a time-stamped note to the LOGBOOK drawer.
1459 @node Blocks, Footnotes, Drawers, Document Structure
1462 @vindex org-hide-block-startup
1463 @cindex blocks, folding
1464 Org-mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including source
1465 code examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) to capturing time logging
1466 information (@pxref{Clocking work time}). These blocks can be folded and
1467 unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also get all blocks
1468 folded at startup by configuring the variable @code{org-hide-block-startup}
1469 or on a per-file basis by using
1471 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1472 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1474 #+STARTUP: hideblocks
1475 #+STARTUP: nohideblocks
1478 @node Footnotes, Orgstruct mode, Blocks, Document Structure
1482 Org-mode supports the creation of footnotes. In contrast to the
1483 @file{footnote.el} package, Org-mode's footnotes are designed for work on a
1484 larger document, not only for one-off documents like emails. The basic
1485 syntax is similar to the one used by @file{footnote.el}, i.e. a footnote is
1486 defined in a paragraph that is started by a footnote marker in square
1487 brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. If you need a paragraph break
1488 inside a footnote, use the La@TeX{} idiom @samp{\par}. The footnote reference
1489 is simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. For example:
1492 The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
1494 [fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
1497 Org-mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and
1498 optional inline definition. Using plain numbers as markers (as
1499 @file{footnote.el} does) is supported for backward compatibility, but not
1500 encouraged because of possible conflicts with La@TeX{} snippets (@pxref{Embedded
1501 LaTeX}). Here are the valid references:
1505 A plain numeric footnote marker. Compatible with @file{footnote.el}, but not
1506 recommended because something like @samp{[1]} could easily be part of a code
1509 A named footnote reference, where @code{name} is a unique label word, or, for
1510 simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
1511 @item [fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]
1512 A La@TeX{}-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the
1514 @item [fn:name: a definition]
1515 An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note.
1516 Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use
1517 @code{[fn:name]} to create additional references.
1520 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
1521 Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names yourself.
1522 This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its
1523 corresponding @code{#+STARTUP} keywords, see the docstring of that variable
1526 @noindent The following command handles footnotes:
1531 The footnote action command.
1533 When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it
1534 is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference.
1536 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
1537 @vindex org-footnote-section
1538 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
1539 Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable
1540 @code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer
1541 setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @code{#+STARTUP: nofninline}}, the
1542 definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or
1543 separately into the location determined by the variable
1544 @code{org-footnote-section}.
1546 When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional
1549 s @r{Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,}
1550 @r{Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular}
1551 @r{sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will}
1552 @r{also move entries according to @code{org-footnote-section}. Automatic}
1553 @r{sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the}
1554 @r{variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1555 r @r{Renumber the simple @code{fn:N} footnotes. Automatic renumbering}
1556 @r{after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the variable}
1557 @r{@code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1558 S @r{Short for first @code{r}, then @code{s} action.}
1559 n @r{Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including}
1560 @r{inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them}
1561 @r{in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. This is}
1562 @r{meant to be the final step before finishing a document (e.g. sending}
1563 @r{off an email). The exporters do this automatically, and so could}
1564 @r{something like @code{message-send-hook}.}
1565 d @r{Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references}
1568 Depending on the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}@footnote{the
1569 corresponding in-buffer options are @code{fnadjust} and @code{nofnadjust}.},
1570 renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each insertion or
1575 If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a
1576 the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote
1577 location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}.
1581 @item C-c C-o @r{or} mouse-1/2
1582 Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and
1583 you can use the usual commands to follow these links.
1586 @node Orgstruct mode, , Footnotes, Document Structure
1587 @section The Orgstruct minor mode
1588 @cindex Orgstruct mode
1589 @cindex minor mode for structure editing
1591 If you like the intuitive way the Org-mode structure editing and list
1592 formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes like
1593 Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode @code{orgstruct-mode} makes
1594 this possible. Toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x orgstruct-mode}, or
1595 turn it on by default, for example in Mail mode, with one of:
1598 (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
1599 (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++)
1602 When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to Org like a
1603 headline or the first line of a list item, most structure editing commands
1604 will work, even if the same keys normally have different functionality in the
1605 major mode you are using. If the cursor is not in one of those special
1606 lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in the shadow. When you use
1607 @code{orgstruct++-mode}, Org will also export indentation and autofill
1608 settings into that mode, and detect item context after the first line of an
1611 @node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document Structure, Top
1614 @cindex editing tables
1616 Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
1617 calculations are supported in connection with the Emacs @file{calc}
1620 (@pxref{Top,Calc,,Calc,Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
1623 (see the Emacs Calculator manual for more information about the Emacs
1628 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
1629 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
1630 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
1631 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
1632 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
1633 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
1636 @node Built-in table editor, Column width and alignment, Tables, Tables
1637 @section The built-in table editor
1638 @cindex table editor, built-in
1640 Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII. Any line with
1641 @samp{|} as the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a
1642 table. @samp{|} is also the column separator. A table might look like
1646 | Name | Phone | Age |
1647 |-------+-------+-----|
1648 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
1649 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
1652 A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
1653 @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
1654 the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
1655 at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
1656 of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
1657 @samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
1658 expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
1659 create the above table, you would only type
1666 @noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
1667 fields. Even faster would be to type @code{|Name|Phone|Age} followed by
1668 @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}.
1670 @vindex org-enable-table-editor
1671 @vindex org-table-auto-blank-field
1672 When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
1673 @key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
1674 inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
1675 typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
1676 with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
1677 field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
1678 unpredictable for you, configure the variables
1679 @code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
1682 @tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
1685 Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one
1686 TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
1687 If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
1688 If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
1689 argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
1690 C-u} forces TAB, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
1691 consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
1693 If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
1694 table. But it's easier just to start typing, like
1695 @kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
1697 @tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
1700 Re-align the table without moving the cursor.
1704 Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
1709 Re-align, move to previous field.
1713 Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
1714 necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
1715 NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
1719 Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the previous field.
1722 Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field.
1724 @tsubheading{Column and row editing}
1725 @kindex M-@key{left}
1726 @kindex M-@key{right}
1728 @itemx M-@key{right}
1729 Move the current column left/right.
1731 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1732 @item M-S-@key{left}
1733 Kill the current column.
1735 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1736 @item M-S-@key{right}
1737 Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
1740 @kindex M-@key{down}
1743 Move the current row up/down.
1745 @kindex M-S-@key{up}
1747 Kill the current row or horizontal line.
1749 @kindex M-S-@key{down}
1750 @item M-S-@key{down}
1751 Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
1752 created below the current one.
1756 Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
1757 is created above the current line.
1759 @kindex C-c @key{RET}
1761 Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor into the row
1766 Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
1767 column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
1768 between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
1769 point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
1770 column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
1771 and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
1772 included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
1773 (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix
1774 argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
1776 @tsubheading{Regions}
1779 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point and
1780 mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there is no active region,
1781 copy just the current field. The process ignores horizontal separator lines.
1785 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
1786 blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
1790 Paste a rectangular region into a table.
1791 The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
1792 will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
1793 the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
1798 Wrap several fields in a column like a paragraph. If there is an active
1799 region, and both point and mark are in the same column, the text in the
1800 column is wrapped to minimum width for the given number of lines. A numeric
1801 prefix argument may be used to change the number of desired lines. If there
1802 is no region, the current field is split at the cursor position and the text
1803 fragment to the right of the cursor is prepended to the field one line
1804 down. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument, the current
1805 field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field above.
1807 @tsubheading{Calculations}
1808 @cindex formula, in tables
1809 @cindex calculations, in tables
1810 @cindex region, active
1811 @cindex active region
1812 @cindex transient mark mode
1815 Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
1816 the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
1817 be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
1821 @vindex org-table-copy-increment
1822 When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
1823 empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
1824 Depending on the variable @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
1825 values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
1826 be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily disables the
1827 increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related modes
1828 (@pxref{Conflicts}).
1830 @tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
1833 Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields that
1834 are not fully visible (@pxref{Column width and alignment}). When called with
1835 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
1838 @item M-x org-table-import
1839 Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace
1840 separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
1841 from a database, because these programs generally can write
1842 TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
1843 the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
1844 argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
1847 Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
1848 buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
1849 @kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
1851 @item M-x org-table-export
1852 @vindex org-table-export-default-format
1853 Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data
1854 exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
1855 used to export the file can be configured in the variable
1856 @code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
1857 @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
1858 name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
1859 general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
1860 format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions}, for a
1861 detailed description.
1864 If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
1865 way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
1869 (setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
1872 @noindent Then the only table command that still works is
1873 @kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
1875 @node Column width and alignment, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables
1876 @section Column width and alignment
1877 @cindex narrow columns in tables
1878 @cindex alignment in tables
1880 The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. And
1881 also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the fraction
1882 of number-like versus non-number fields in the column.
1884 Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text, leading to
1885 inconveniently wide columns. Or maybe you want to make a table with several
1886 columns having a fixed width, regardless of content. To set@footnote{This
1887 feature does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere
1888 in the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an
1889 integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next re-align
1890 will then set the width of this column to this value.
1894 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
1896 | 1 | one | | 1 | one |
1897 | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
1898 | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
1899 | 4 | four | | 4 | four |
1900 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
1905 Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
1906 Note that the full text is still in the buffer, it is only invisible.
1907 To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field---a tool-tip window
1908 will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
1909 @kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will
1910 open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
1913 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
1914 When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
1915 necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
1916 be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
1917 @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
1918 upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
1919 on a per-file basis with:
1926 If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich columns
1927 to the right and of string-rich column to the left, you and use @samp{<r>} or
1928 @samp{<l>} in a similar fashion. You may also combine alignment and field
1929 width like this: @samp{<l10>}.
1931 Lines which only contain these formatting cookies will be removed
1932 automatically when exporting the document.
1934 @node Column groups, Orgtbl mode, Column width and alignment, Tables
1935 @section Column groups
1936 @cindex grouping columns in tables
1938 When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical
1939 lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
1940 however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
1941 of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
1942 order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
1943 first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either
1944 contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group,
1945 @samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} to make a column
1946 a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be
1947 marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
1950 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
1951 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
1952 | / | < | | > | < | > |
1953 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
1954 | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
1955 | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
1956 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
1957 #+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1)))
1960 It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
1961 every vertical line you would like to have:
1964 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
1965 |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
1969 @node Orgtbl mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables
1970 @section The Orgtbl minor mode
1972 @cindex minor mode for tables
1974 If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
1975 might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
1976 The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
1977 the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for
1978 example in mail mode, use
1981 (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
1984 Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
1985 in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
1986 construct La@TeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
1987 Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
1988 @ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
1990 @node The spreadsheet, Org-Plot, Orgtbl mode, Tables
1991 @section The spreadsheet
1992 @cindex calculations, in tables
1993 @cindex spreadsheet capabilities
1994 @cindex @file{calc} package
1996 The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
1997 spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
1998 derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's implementation
1999 is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example, Org knows the concept
2000 of a @emph{column formula} that will be applied to all non-header fields in a
2001 column without having to copy the formula to each relevant field. There is
2002 also a formula debugger, and a formula editor with features for highlighting
2003 fields in the table corresponding to the references at the point in the
2004 formula, moving these references by arrow keys
2007 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
2008 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
2009 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
2010 * Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
2011 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
2012 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
2013 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
2014 * Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
2017 @node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet
2018 @subsection References
2021 To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
2022 reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
2023 by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
2024 out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
2025 field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
2027 @subsubheading Field references
2028 @cindex field references
2029 @cindex references, to fields
2031 Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
2032 any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
2033 combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
2034 @c Such references are always fixed to that field, they don't change
2035 @c when you copy and paste a formula to a different field. So
2036 @c Org's @code{B3} behaves like @code{$B$3} in other spreadsheets.
2039 Org also uses another, more general operator that looks like this:
2041 @@@var{row}$@var{column}
2045 Column references can be absolute like @samp{1}, @samp{2},...@samp{@var{N}},
2046 or relative to the current column like @samp{+1} or @samp{-2}.
2048 The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal
2049 separator lines (hlines). You can use absolute row numbers
2050 @samp{1}...@samp{@var{N}}, and row numbers relative to the current row like
2051 @samp{+3} or @samp{-1}. Or specify the row relative to one of the
2052 hlines: @samp{I} refers to the first hline@footnote{Note that only
2053 hlines are counted that @emph{separate} table lines. If the table
2054 starts with a hline above the header, it does not count.}, @samp{II} to
2055 the second, etc@. @samp{-I} refers to the first such line above the
2056 current line, @samp{+I} to the first such line below the current line.
2057 You can also write @samp{III+2} which is the second data line after the
2058 third hline in the table.
2060 @samp{0} refers to the current row and column. Also, if you omit
2061 either the column or the row part of the reference, the current
2062 row/column is implied.
2064 Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
2065 in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
2066 different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
2067 Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
2068 references because the same reference operator can reference different
2069 fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
2071 As a special case, references like @samp{$LR5} and @samp{$LR12} can be used
2072 to refer in a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the
2075 Here are a few examples:
2078 @@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column}
2079 C2 @r{same as previous}
2080 $5 @r{column 5 in the current row}
2081 E& @r{same as previous}
2082 @@2 @r{current column, row 2}
2083 @@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
2084 @@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
2087 @subsubheading Range references
2088 @cindex range references
2089 @cindex references, to ranges
2091 You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
2092 references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
2093 current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
2094 is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
2095 format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
2096 @samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
2099 $1..$3 @r{First three fields in the current row.}
2100 $P..$Q @r{Range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
2101 @@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields.}
2102 A2..C4 @r{Same as above.}
2103 @@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{3 numbers from the column to the left, 2 up to current row}
2106 @noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
2107 into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally
2108 suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but
2109 see the @samp{E} mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields,
2110 @samp{[0]} is returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas.
2112 @subsubheading Field coordinates in formulas
2113 @cindex field coordinates
2114 @cindex coordinates, of field
2115 @cindex row, of field coordinates
2116 @cindex column, of field coordinates
2118 For Calc formulas and Lisp formulas @code{@@#} and @code{$#} can be used to
2119 get the row or column number of the field where the formula result goes.
2120 The traditional Lisp formula equivalents are @code{org-table-current-dline}
2121 and @code{org-table-current-column}. Examples:
2124 if(@@# % 2, $#, string("")) @r{column number on odd lines only}
2125 $3 = remote(FOO, @@@@#$2) @r{copy column 2 from table FOO into}
2126 @r{column 3 of the current table}
2129 @noindent For the second example, table FOO must have at least as many rows
2130 as the current table. Inefficient@footnote{The computation time scales as
2131 O(N^2) because table FOO is parsed for each field to be copied.} for large
2134 @subsubheading Named references
2135 @cindex named references
2136 @cindex references, named
2137 @cindex name, of column or field
2138 @cindex constants, in calculations
2141 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
2142 @samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
2143 constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable
2144 @code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
2148 #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
2152 @vindex constants-unit-system
2153 @pindex constants.el
2154 Also properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as
2155 constants in table formulas: for a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
2156 @samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
2157 outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
2158 @file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
2159 including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
2160 units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{constants.el} can
2161 supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
2162 and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
2163 @code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
2164 @code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
2165 buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
2166 lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
2167 names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
2170 @subsubheading Remote references
2171 @cindex remote references
2172 @cindex references, remote
2173 @cindex references, to a different table
2174 @cindex name, of column or field
2175 @cindex constants, in calculations
2178 You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table,
2179 either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is
2182 remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF)
2186 where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a
2187 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} line before the table. It can also be the ID of an
2188 entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first
2189 table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference as
2190 described above for example @code{@@3$3} or @code{$somename}, valid in the
2193 @node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet
2194 @subsection Formula syntax for Calc
2195 @cindex formula syntax, Calc
2196 @cindex syntax, of formulas
2198 A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs
2199 @file{Calc} package. @b{Note that @file{calc} has the
2200 non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than
2201 @samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}.} Before
2202 evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc from
2203 Your Programs,calc-eval,Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs,Calc,GNU
2204 Emacs Calc Manual}),
2205 @c FIXME: The link to the Calc manual in HTML does not work.
2206 variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above.
2207 @cindex vectors, in table calculations
2208 The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
2209 like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
2211 @cindex format specifier
2212 @cindex mode, for @file{calc}
2213 @vindex org-calc-default-modes
2214 A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
2215 string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
2216 execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
2217 12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
2218 format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 8)} to keep tables
2219 compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable
2220 @code{org-calc-default-modes}.
2223 p20 @r{set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits}
2224 n3 s3 e2 f4 @r{Normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed}
2225 @r{format of the result of Calc passed back to Org.}
2226 @r{Calc formatting is unlimited in precision as}
2227 @r{long as the Calc calculation precision is greater.}
2228 D R @r{angle modes: degrees, radians}
2229 F S @r{fraction and symbolic modes}
2230 N @r{interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers}
2231 T @r{force text interpretation}
2232 E @r{keep empty fields in ranges}
2237 Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision-calculation
2238 and -display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide a
2239 @code{printf} format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has been
2240 passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the
2241 formatting@footnote{The @code{printf} reformatting is limited in precision
2242 because the value passed to it is converted into an @code{integer} or
2243 @code{double}. The @code{integer} is limited in size by truncating the
2244 signed value to 32 bits. The @code{double} is limited in precision to 64
2245 bits overall which leaves approximately 16 significant decimal digits.}.
2249 $1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
2250 $1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
2251 exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
2252 $0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
2253 ($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
2254 $c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
2255 tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
2256 sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
2257 vmean($2..$7) @r{Compute column range mean, using vector function}
2258 vmean($2..$7);EN @r{Same, but treat empty fields as 0}
2259 taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
2262 Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example
2265 if($1<20,teen,string("")) @r{``teen'' if age $1 less than 20, else empty}
2268 @node Formula syntax for Lisp, Field formulas, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet
2269 @subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
2270 @cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
2272 It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp; this can be useful
2273 for string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's
2274 functionality is not enough. If a formula starts with a single-quote
2275 followed by an opening parenthesis, then it is evaluated as a Lisp form.
2276 The evaluation should return either a string or a number. Just as with
2277 @file{calc} formulas, you can specify modes and a printf format after a
2278 semicolon. With Emacs Lisp forms, you need to be conscious about the way
2279 field references are interpolated into the form. By default, a
2280 reference will be interpolated as a Lisp string (in double-quotes)
2281 containing the field. If you provide the @samp{N} mode switch, all
2282 referenced elements will be numbers (non-number fields will be zero) and
2283 interpolated as Lisp numbers, without quotes. If you provide the
2284 @samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated literally, without quotes.
2285 I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted as a string by the Lisp
2286 form, enclose the reference operator itself in double-quotes, like
2287 @code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated fields, so you can
2288 embed them in list or vector syntax. A few examples, note how the
2289 @samp{N} mode is used when we do computations in Lisp.
2292 @r{Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1}
2293 '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
2294 @r{Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's @code{$1+$2}}
2296 @r{Compute the sum of columns 1-4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}}
2297 '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
2300 @node Field formulas, Column formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet
2301 @subsection Field formulas
2302 @cindex field formula
2303 @cindex formula, for individual table field
2305 To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the
2306 field, preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=$1+$2}. When you
2307 press @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in
2308 the field, the formula will be stored as the formula for this field,
2309 evaluated, and the current field replaced with the result.
2312 Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:}
2313 directly below the table. If you typed the equation in the 4th field of
2314 the 3rd data line in the table, the formula will look like
2315 @samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows
2316 with the appropriate commands, @i{absolute references} (but not relative
2317 ones) in stored formulas are modified in order to still reference the
2318 same field. Of course this is not true if you edit the table structure
2319 with normal editing commands---then you must fix the equations yourself.
2320 The left-hand side of a formula may also be a named field (@pxref{Advanced
2321 features}), or a last-row reference like @samp{$LR3}.
2323 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2329 Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
2330 formula with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
2331 it to the current field, and stores it.
2334 @node Column formulas, Editing and debugging formulas, Field formulas, The spreadsheet
2335 @subsection Column formulas
2336 @cindex column formula
2337 @cindex formula, for table column
2339 Often in a table, the same formula should be used for all fields in a
2340 particular column. Instead of having to copy the formula to all fields
2341 in that column, Org allows you to assign a single formula to an entire
2342 column. If the table contains horizontal separator hlines, everything
2343 before the first such line is considered part of the table @emph{header}
2344 and will not be modified by column formulas.
2346 To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
2347 column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
2348 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2349 the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated
2350 and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains only
2351 @samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is used. For each
2352 column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In the
2353 @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like @samp{$4=$1+$2}. The left-hand
2354 side of a column formula cannot currently be the name of column, it
2355 must be the numeric column reference.
2357 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2363 Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
2364 the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
2365 taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
2366 stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g. @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
2367 will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
2370 @node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Column formulas, The spreadsheet
2371 @subsection Editing and debugging formulas
2372 @cindex formula editing
2373 @cindex editing, of table formulas
2375 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2376 You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
2377 field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active
2378 formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org
2379 converts references to the standard format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&})
2380 if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like
2381 @code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the variable
2382 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
2389 Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
2390 minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas}, and @ref{Field formulas}.
2391 @kindex C-u C-u C-c =
2393 Re-insert the active formula (either a
2394 field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
2395 can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
2396 minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
2399 While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
2400 referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
2403 Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using
2404 overlays. These are updated each time the table is aligned; you can
2405 force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
2408 Toggle the formula debugger on and off. See below.
2411 Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
2412 formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
2413 active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
2414 While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
2415 any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
2416 remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
2422 Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
2423 prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
2426 Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
2429 Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
2430 @code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
2433 Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
2434 a Lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
2435 Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
2436 formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2439 Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2441 @kindex S-@key{down}
2442 @kindex S-@key{left}
2443 @kindex S-@key{right}
2444 @item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
2445 Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
2446 @code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
2447 This also works for relative references and for hline references.
2448 @kindex M-S-@key{up}
2449 @kindex M-S-@key{down}
2450 @item M-S-@key{up}/@key{down}
2451 Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
2454 @kindex M-@key{down}
2455 @item M-@key{up}/@key{down}
2456 Scroll the window displaying the table.
2459 Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
2463 Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
2464 the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{#+TBLFM}
2465 line)---during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
2466 To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
2467 prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
2470 You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
2471 equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line or with the normal
2472 recalculation commands in the table.
2474 @subsubheading Debugging formulas
2475 @cindex formula debugging
2476 @cindex debugging, of table formulas
2477 When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
2478 becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
2479 on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
2480 turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
2481 calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
2482 field. Detailed information will be displayed.
2484 @node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet
2485 @subsection Updating the table
2486 @cindex recomputing table fields
2487 @cindex updating, table
2489 Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
2490 triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features}, for a way to make
2491 recalculation at least semi-automatic.
2493 In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
2499 Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
2500 from left to right, and all field formulas in the current row.
2506 Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
2507 hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
2509 @kindex C-u C-u C-c *
2510 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-c
2512 @itemx C-u C-u C-c C-c
2513 Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
2514 This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
2515 fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
2516 @item M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2517 Recompute all tables in the current buffer.
2518 @item M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2519 Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge table-to-table
2523 @node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet
2524 @subsection Advanced features
2526 If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if
2527 you want to be able to assign @i{names} to fields and columns, you need
2528 to reserve the first column of the table for special marking characters.
2532 Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{ },
2533 @samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
2534 change all marks in the region.
2537 Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
2538 makes use of these features:
2542 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2543 | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
2544 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2545 | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
2546 | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
2547 | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
2548 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2549 | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
2550 | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
2551 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2552 | | Average | | | | 29.7 | |
2553 | ^ | | | | | at | |
2554 | $ | max=50 | | | | | |
2555 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2556 #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
2560 @noindent @b{Important}: please note that for these special tables,
2561 recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
2562 are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
2563 to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
2566 @cindex marking characters, tables
2567 The marking characters have the following meaning:
2570 The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
2571 refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
2573 This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
2574 a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
2575 the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
2576 will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
2578 Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
2581 Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
2582 example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
2583 formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
2584 Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
2587 Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
2588 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
2589 is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
2590 lines will be left alone by this command.
2592 Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
2593 not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
2594 recalculation slows down editing too much.
2596 Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
2597 All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
2600 Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
2601 @samp{<N>} markers or column group markers.
2604 Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the
2605 fantastic @file{calc.el} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
2606 series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
2611 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2612 | | Func | n | x | Result |
2613 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2614 | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
2615 | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
2616 | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
2617 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
2618 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
2619 | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
2620 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2621 #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
2625 @node Org-Plot, , The spreadsheet, Tables
2627 @cindex graph, in tables
2628 @cindex plot tables using Gnuplot
2631 Org-Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org tables
2632 using @file{Gnuplot} @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
2633 @uref{http://cars9.uchicago.edu/~ravel/software/gnuplot-mode.html}. To see
2634 this in action, ensure that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed
2635 on your system, then call @code{org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table.
2639 #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
2640 | Sede | Max cites | H-index |
2641 |-----------+-----------+---------|
2642 | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
2643 | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
2644 | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
2645 | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
2646 | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
2650 Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as labels.
2651 Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
2652 be exercised through the @code{#+PLOT:} lines preceding a table. See below
2653 for a complete list of Org-plot options. For more information and examples
2654 see the Org-plot tutorial at
2655 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.php}.
2657 @subsubheading Plot Options
2661 Specify any @command{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
2664 Specify the title of the plot.
2667 Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
2670 Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by parentheses
2671 and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
2672 fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the @code{ind}
2676 Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
2679 Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
2680 (e.g. @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
2681 Defaults to @code{lines}.
2684 If you want to plot to a file, specify @code{"@var{path/to/desired/output-file}"}.
2687 List of labels to be used for the deps (defaults to the column headers if
2691 Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script.
2694 When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
2695 flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
2698 Specify format of Org-mode timestamps as they will be parsed by Gnuplot.
2699 Defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S}.
2702 If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place the file name
2703 between double-quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
2704 instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
2705 the path to the generated data file. Note: even if you set this option, you
2706 may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
2710 @node Hyperlinks, TODO Items, Tables, Top
2714 Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
2715 other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
2718 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
2719 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
2720 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
2721 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
2722 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
2723 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
2724 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
2725 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
2728 @node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks
2729 @section Link format
2731 @cindex format, of links
2733 Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
2734 clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
2737 [[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
2741 Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
2742 will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
2743 of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
2744 @samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
2745 which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
2746 visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
2747 part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
2748 edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
2751 If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
2752 displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
2753 (invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
2754 and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
2755 missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
2756 internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
2757 @code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
2759 @node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks
2760 @section Internal links
2761 @cindex internal links
2762 @cindex links, internal
2763 @cindex targets, for links
2765 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
2766 If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in the
2767 current file. The most important case is a link like
2768 @samp{[[#my-custom-id]]} which will link to the entry with the
2769 @code{CUSTOM_ID} property @samp{my-custom-id}. Such custom IDs are very good
2770 for HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}) where they produce pretty section
2771 links. You are responsible yourself to make sure these custom IDs are unique
2774 Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My Target][Find my target]]}
2775 lead to a text search in the current file.
2777 The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the link,
2778 or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). Links to custom IDs will
2779 point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for a text link is
2780 a @i{dedicated target}: the same string in double angular brackets. Targets
2781 may be located anywhere; sometimes it is convenient to put them into a
2782 comment line. For example
2788 @noindent In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such targets will become
2789 named anchors for direct access through @samp{http} links@footnote{Note that
2790 text before the first headline is usually not exported, so the first such
2791 target should be after the first headline, or in the line directly before the
2794 If no dedicated target exists, Org will search for a headline that is exactly
2795 the link text but may also include a TODO keyword and tags@footnote{To insert
2796 a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can be used. Just type a
2797 star followed by a few optional letters into the buffer and press
2798 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current buffer will be offered as
2799 completions.}. In non-Org files, the search will look for the words in the
2800 link text, in the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}.
2802 Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
2803 return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
2804 several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
2808 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
2811 @node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links
2812 @subsection Radio targets
2813 @cindex radio targets
2814 @cindex targets, radio
2815 @cindex links, radio targets
2817 Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
2818 in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
2819 text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
2820 enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
2821 Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
2822 become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
2823 for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
2824 update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
2825 cursor on or at a target.
2827 @node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks
2828 @section External links
2829 @cindex links, external
2830 @cindex external links
2831 @cindex links, external
2839 @cindex WANDERLUST links
2841 @cindex USENET links
2846 Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages,
2847 BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their
2848 logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
2849 identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
2850 the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
2853 http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
2854 doi:10.1000/182 @r{DOI for an electronic resource}
2855 file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
2856 /home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
2857 file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
2858 ./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
2859 file:/myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{file, path on remote machine}
2860 /myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
2861 file:sometextfile::NNN @r{file with line number to jump to}
2862 file:projects.org @r{another Org file}
2863 file:projects.org::some words @r{text search in Org file}
2864 file:projects.org::*task title @r{heading search in Org file}
2865 docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN @r{open file in doc-view mode at page NNN}
2866 id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 @r{Link to heading by ID}
2867 news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
2868 mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
2869 vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
2870 vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
2871 vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
2872 wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
2873 wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
2874 mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
2875 mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
2876 rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
2877 rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
2878 gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
2879 gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
2880 bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
2881 irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
2882 info:org:External%20links @r{Info node link (with encoded space)}
2883 shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
2884 elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive Elisp command}
2885 elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
2888 A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a
2889 descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link
2890 format}), for example:
2893 [[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
2897 If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
2898 export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
2899 button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
2901 that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
2903 @cindex square brackets, around links
2904 @cindex plain text external links
2905 Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
2906 as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
2907 @samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
2908 about the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets.
2910 @node Handling links, Using links outside Org, External links, Hyperlinks
2911 @section Handling links
2912 @cindex links, handling
2914 Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
2915 insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
2919 @cindex storing links
2921 Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command (you
2922 must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in any buffer to
2923 create a link. The link will be stored for later insertion into an Org
2924 buffer (see below). What kind of link will be created depends on the current
2927 @b{Org-mode buffers}@*
2928 For Org files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points
2929 to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, which will also
2932 @vindex org-link-to-org-use-id
2933 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
2934 @cindex property, ID
2935 If the headline has a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property, a link to this custom ID
2936 will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the value of
2937 @code{org-link-to-org-use-id}), a globally unique @code{ID} property will be
2938 created and/or used to construct a link. So using this command in Org
2939 buffers will potentially create two links: a human-readable from the custom
2940 ID, and one that is globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from
2941 file to file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one
2944 @b{Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus}@*
2945 Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will point to the
2946 current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the group. The description is
2947 constructed from the author and the subject.
2949 @b{Web browsers: W3 and W3M}@*
2950 Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as description.
2952 @b{Contacts: BBDB}@*
2953 Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry.
2956 @vindex org-irc-link-to-logs
2957 For IRC links, if you set the variable @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to
2958 @code{t}, a @samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for
2959 the current conversation is created. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to
2960 the user/channel/server under the point will be stored.
2963 For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string
2964 (@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If
2965 there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the
2966 search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or
2967 accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
2968 and to do the search for particular file types---see @ref{Custom searches}.
2969 The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion---see @ref{Installation}.
2972 When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to the
2973 entry referenced by the current line.
2977 @cindex link completion
2978 @cindex completion, of links
2979 @cindex inserting links
2981 @vindex org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion
2982 Insert a link@footnote{ Note that you don't have to use this command to
2983 insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them
2984 straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically
2985 enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional
2986 descriptive text.}. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer.
2987 You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
2988 type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. The link will be inserted
2989 into the buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be
2990 removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use
2991 a triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
2992 @code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
2993 If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
2994 becomes the default description.
2996 @b{Inserting stored links}@*
2997 All links stored during the
2998 current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
2999 them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}).
3001 @b{Completion support}@* Completion with @key{TAB} will help you to insert
3002 valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes
3003 defined through link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). If you
3004 press @key{RET} after inserting only the @var{prefix}, Org will offer
3005 specific completion support for some link types@footnote{This works by
3006 calling a special function @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link}.} For
3007 example, if you type @kbd{file @key{RET}}, file name completion (alternative
3008 access: @kbd{C-u C-c C-l}, see below) will be offered, and after @kbd{bbdb
3009 @key{RET}} you can complete contact names.
3011 @cindex file name completion
3012 @cindex completion, of file names
3014 When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
3015 a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
3016 the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
3017 directory of the current Org file, if the linked file is in the current
3018 directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
3019 to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
3020 is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
3021 force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
3023 @item C-c C-l @ @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
3024 When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
3025 link and description parts of the link.
3027 @cindex following links
3030 @item C-c C-o @ @r{(or, if @code{org-return-follows-link} is set, also} @key{RET}
3031 @vindex org-file-apps
3032 Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
3033 @command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
3034 the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
3035 cursor is on an internal link, this command runs the corresponding search.
3036 When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
3037 TAGS view. If the cursor is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that
3038 date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
3039 with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
3040 Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
3041 @code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
3042 visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
3043 opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.@*
3044 If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in the
3045 headline and entry text.
3051 On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o}
3052 would. Under Emacs 22, @kbd{mouse-1} will also follow a link.
3056 @vindex org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer
3057 Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
3058 internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
3059 variable @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
3061 @cindex inlining images
3062 @cindex images, inlining
3065 Toggle the inline display of linked images. Normally this will only inline
3066 images that have no description part in the link, i.e. images that will also
3067 be inlined during export. When called with a prefix argument, also display
3068 images that do have a link description.
3072 Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
3073 easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
3075 @cindex links, returning to
3078 Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
3079 commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
3080 command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
3081 previously recorded positions.
3085 @cindex links, finding next/previous
3088 Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
3089 the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
3090 bindings for this are really too long, you might want to bind this also
3091 to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
3093 (add-hook 'org-load-hook
3095 (define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
3096 (define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
3100 @node Using links outside Org, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks
3101 @section Using links outside Org
3103 You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
3104 Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
3105 global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
3109 (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
3110 (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
3113 @node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org, Hyperlinks
3114 @section Link abbreviations
3115 @cindex link abbreviations
3116 @cindex abbreviation, links
3118 Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
3119 needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
3120 abbreviated link looks like this
3123 [[linkword:tag][description]]
3127 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
3128 where the tag is optional.
3129 The @i{linkword} must be a word, starting with a letter, followed by
3130 letters, numbers, @samp{-}, and @samp{_}. Abbreviations are resolved
3131 according to the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}
3132 that relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
3136 (setq org-link-abbrev-alist
3137 '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
3138 ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
3139 ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/
3140 nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
3144 If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
3145 replaced with the tag. Otherwise the tag will be appended to the string
3146 in order to create the link. You may also specify a function that will
3147 be called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
3149 With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
3150 @code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
3151 @code{[[google:OrgMode]]} and find out what the Org author is
3152 doing besides Emacs hacking with @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
3154 If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
3155 can define them in the file with
3159 #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
3160 #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
3164 In-buffer completion (@pxref{Completion}) can be used after @samp{[} to
3165 complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function
3166 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g. completion)
3167 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
3168 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
3170 @node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks
3171 @section Search options in file links
3172 @cindex search option in file links
3173 @cindex file links, searching
3175 File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
3176 particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
3177 line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
3178 compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
3179 example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
3180 links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
3181 string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
3182 link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
3184 Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
3185 link, together with an explanation:
3188 [[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
3189 [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
3190 [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
3191 [[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]]
3192 [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
3199 Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
3200 @samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
3201 @ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
3202 link will become an HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
3205 In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
3207 Link to a heading with a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property
3209 Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
3210 command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
3211 target file is in Org-mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
3212 sparse tree with the matches.
3213 @c If the target file is a directory,
3214 @c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
3217 As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
3218 to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
3219 a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
3220 @samp{[[find me]]} would.
3222 @node Custom searches, , Search options, Hyperlinks
3223 @section Custom Searches
3224 @cindex custom search strings
3225 @cindex search strings, custom
3227 The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
3228 actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
3229 cases. For example, Bib@TeX{} database files have many entries like
3230 @samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
3231 because the only unique identification for a Bib@TeX{} entry is the
3234 @vindex org-create-file-search-functions
3235 @vindex org-execute-file-search-functions
3236 If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
3237 the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
3238 for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
3239 to be added to the hook variables
3240 @code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
3241 @code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
3242 variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
3243 for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
3244 an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
3246 @node TODO Items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top
3250 Org-mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
3251 course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items,
3252 but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
3253 notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
3254 mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
3255 information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
3256 item emerged is always present.
3258 Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
3259 throughout your notes file. Org-mode compensates for this by providing
3260 methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
3263 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
3264 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
3265 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
3266 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
3267 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
3268 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
3271 @node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO Items, TODO Items
3272 @section Basic TODO functionality
3274 Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
3275 @samp{TODO}, for example:
3278 *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
3282 The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
3286 @cindex cycling, of TODO states
3288 Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
3291 ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
3292 '--------------------------------'
3295 The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and
3296 agenda buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3300 Select a specific keyword using completion or (if it has been set up)
3301 the fast selection interface. For the latter, you need to assign keys
3302 to TODO states, see @ref{Per-file keywords}, and @ref{Setting tags}, for
3305 @kindex S-@key{right}
3306 @kindex S-@key{left}
3307 @vindex org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change
3310 Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
3311 mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
3312 extensions}). See also @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction
3313 with @code{shift-selection-mode}. See also the variable
3314 @code{org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change}.
3316 @cindex sparse tree, for TODO
3318 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3319 View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds the
3320 entire buffer, but shows all TODO items (with not-DONE state) and the
3321 headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix argument (or by using @kbd{C-c
3322 / T}), search for a specific TODO. You will be prompted for the keyword, and
3323 you can also give a list of keywords like @code{KWD1|KWD2|...} to list
3324 entries that match any one of these keywords. With numeric prefix argument
3325 N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the variable
3326 @code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix arguments, find all TODO states,
3327 both un-done and done.
3330 Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with not-DONE states)
3331 from all agenda files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new
3332 buffer will be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
3333 manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3334 @xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
3335 @kindex S-M-@key{RET}
3337 Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
3341 @vindex org-todo-state-tags-triggers
3342 Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
3343 option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
3345 @node TODO extensions, Progress logging, TODO basics, TODO Items
3346 @section Extended use of TODO keywords
3347 @cindex extended TODO keywords
3349 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3350 By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
3351 DONE. Org-mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
3352 with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
3353 special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
3356 Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
3357 TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
3360 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
3361 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
3362 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
3363 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
3364 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
3365 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
3366 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
3369 @node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions
3370 @subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
3371 @cindex TODO workflow
3372 @cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
3374 You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
3375 in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
3376 this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org-mode in a
3380 (setq org-todo-keywords
3381 '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
3384 The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
3385 action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
3386 you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
3388 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
3389 With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
3390 to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED. You may
3391 also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
3392 example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY.
3393 Or you can use @kbd{S-@key{left}} to go backward through the sequence. If you
3394 define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
3395 (@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
3396 (@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
3397 buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
3398 @ref{Tracking TODO state changes}, for more information.
3400 @node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions
3401 @subsection TODO keywords as types
3403 @cindex names as TODO keywords
3404 @cindex types as TODO keywords
3406 The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
3407 @emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
3408 that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
3409 people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
3410 directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
3411 be set up like this:
3414 (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
3417 In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
3418 different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a
3419 person, and later to mark it DONE. Org-mode supports this style by adapting
3420 the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the
3421 @kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When used several
3422 times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first
3423 select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some
3424 time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly
3425 to DONE. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific
3426 name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree
3427 by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c / t}. For example, to see all things
3428 Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c / t}. To collect Lucy's items
3429 from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix
3430 argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c a t}.
3432 @node Multiple sets in one file, Fast access to TODO states, TODO types, TODO extensions
3433 @subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
3434 @cindex TODO keyword sets
3436 Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
3437 parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
3438 @code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
3439 separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
3440 DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
3444 (setq org-todo-keywords
3445 '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
3446 (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
3447 (sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
3450 The keywords should all be different, this helps Org-mode to keep track
3451 of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
3452 @kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
3453 @code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
3454 (nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
3455 select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
3456 keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
3459 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
3460 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
3461 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-t
3462 @item C-u C-u C-c C-t
3463 @itemx C-S-@key{right}
3464 @itemx C-S-@key{left}
3465 These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
3466 @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} or @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or
3467 @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to
3468 @code{CANCELED}. Note that the @kbd{C-S-} key binding conflict with
3469 @code{shift-selection-mode} (@pxref{Conflicts}).
3470 @kindex S-@key{right}
3471 @kindex S-@key{left}
3474 @kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through @emph{all}
3475 keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} would switch
3476 from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above. See also
3477 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
3478 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
3481 @node Fast access to TODO states, Per-file keywords, Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions
3482 @subsection Fast access to TODO states
3484 If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
3485 instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for
3486 single-letter access to the states. This is done by adding the section
3487 key after each keyword, in parentheses. For example:
3490 (setq org-todo-keywords
3491 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
3492 (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
3493 (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
3496 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo
3497 If you then press @code{C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the entry
3498 will be switched to this state. @key{SPC} can be used to remove any TODO
3499 keyword from an entry.@footnote{Check also the variable
3500 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows you to change the TODO
3501 state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you like to
3502 mingle the two concepts. Note that this means you need to come up with
3503 unique keys across both sets of keywords.}
3505 @node Per-file keywords, Faces for TODO keywords, Fast access to TODO states, TODO extensions
3506 @subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
3507 @cindex keyword options
3508 @cindex per-file keywords
3513 It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
3514 different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
3515 to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
3516 only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
3517 need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
3521 #+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
3523 @noindent (you may also write @code{#+SEQ_TODO} to be explicit about the
3524 interpretation, but it means the same as @code{#+TODO}), or
3526 #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
3529 A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
3533 #+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
3537 @cindex completion, of option keywords
3539 @noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
3540 @samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
3542 @cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
3543 Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
3544 if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
3545 may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
3546 @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
3547 known to Org-mode@footnote{Org-mode parses these lines only when
3548 Org-mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3549 cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org-mode
3550 for the current buffer.}.
3552 @node Faces for TODO keywords, TODO dependencies, Per-file keywords, TODO extensions
3553 @subsection Faces for TODO keywords
3554 @cindex faces, for TODO keywords
3556 @vindex org-todo @r{(face)}
3557 @vindex org-done @r{(face)}
3558 @vindex org-todo-keyword-faces
3559 Org-mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
3560 for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
3561 @code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
3562 you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
3563 special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
3564 @code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
3568 (setq org-todo-keyword-faces
3569 '(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow")
3570 ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
3574 While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED @emph{should}
3575 work, this does not aways seem to be the case. If necessary, define a
3576 special face and use that. A string is interpreted as a color. The variable
3577 @code{org-faces-easy-properties} determines if that color is interpreted as a
3578 foreground or a background color.
3580 @node TODO dependencies, , Faces for TODO keywords, TODO extensions
3581 @subsection TODO dependencies
3582 @cindex TODO dependencies
3583 @cindex dependencies, of TODO states
3585 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
3586 @cindex property, ORDERED
3587 The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to define TODO
3588 dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked DONE until
3589 all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked as DONE. And sometimes
3590 there is a logical sequence to a number of (sub)tasks, so that one task
3591 cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it are done. If you customize
3592 the variable @code{org-enforce-todo-dependencies}, Org will block entries
3593 from changing state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE.
3594 Furthermore, if an entry has a property @code{ORDERED}, each of its children
3595 will be blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE. Here is an
3599 * TODO Blocked until (two) is done
3608 ** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
3609 ** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
3615 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
3616 @cindex property, ORDERED
3617 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the current entry. A property is used
3618 for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not
3619 inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of
3620 this property with a tag for better visibility, customize the variable
3621 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
3622 @kindex C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t
3623 @item C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t
3624 Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking.
3627 @vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
3628 If you set the variable @code{org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks}, TODO entries
3629 that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a dimmed
3630 font or even made invisible in agenda views (@pxref{Agenda Views}).
3632 @cindex checkboxes and TODO dependencies
3633 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
3634 You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes
3635 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). If you set the variable
3636 @code{org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies}, an entry that has unchecked
3637 checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE.
3639 If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies
3640 between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed
3641 module @file{org-depend.el}.
3644 @node Progress logging, Priorities, TODO extensions, TODO Items
3645 @section Progress logging
3646 @cindex progress logging
3647 @cindex logging, of progress
3649 Org-mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when
3650 you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
3651 a TODO item. This system is highly configurable, settings can be on a
3652 per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
3653 information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
3657 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
3658 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
3659 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
3662 @node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging
3663 @subsection Closing items
3665 The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
3666 item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
3667 in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}.
3670 (setq org-log-done 'time)
3674 Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
3675 of the DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted
3676 just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
3677 through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you
3678 want to record a note along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The
3679 corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}}
3682 (setq org-log-done 'note)
3686 You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
3687 the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
3689 In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in the agenda
3690 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), you can then use the @kbd{l} key to
3691 display the TODO items with a @samp{CLOSED} timestamp on each day,
3692 giving you an overview of what has been done.
3694 @node Tracking TODO state changes, Tracking your habits, Closing items, Progress logging
3695 @subsection Tracking TODO state changes
3696 @cindex drawer, for state change recording
3698 @vindex org-log-states-order-reversed
3699 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
3700 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
3701 When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow states}), you
3702 might want to keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe take a
3703 note about this change. You can either record just a timestamp, or a
3704 time-stamped note for a change. These records will be inserted after the
3705 headline as an itemized list, newest first@footnote{See the variable
3706 @code{org-log-states-order-reversed}}. When taking a lot of notes, you might
3707 want to get the notes out of the way into a drawer (@pxref{Drawers}).
3708 Customize the variable @code{org-log-into-drawer} to get this
3709 behavior---the recommended drawer for this is called @code{LOGBOOK}. You can
3710 also overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
3711 @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
3713 Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org-mode
3714 expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by
3715 adding special markers @samp{!} (for a timestamp) and @samp{@@} (for a note)
3716 in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the setting
3719 (setq org-todo-keywords
3720 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
3724 @vindex org-log-done
3725 you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
3726 request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to
3727 DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org-mode will record two timestamps
3728 when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
3729 However, it will never prompt for two notes---if you have configured
3730 both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
3731 the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
3732 WAIT or CANCELED. The setting for WAIT is even more special: the
3733 @samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
3734 entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
3735 WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
3736 logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
3737 to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
3738 when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
3739 setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
3742 You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
3745 #+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
3748 @cindex property, LOGGING
3749 In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
3750 single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
3751 LOGGING property resets all logging settings to nil. You may then turn
3752 on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
3753 @code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
3754 settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
3757 * TODO Log each state with only a time
3759 :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
3761 * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
3763 :LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
3765 * TODO No logging at all
3771 @node Tracking your habits, , Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging
3772 @subsection Tracking your habits
3775 Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of TODOs,
3776 called ``habits''. A habit has the following properties:
3780 You have enabled the @code{habits} module by customizing the variable
3783 The habit is a TODO, with a TODO keyword representing an open state.
3785 The property @code{STYLE} is set to the value @code{habit}.
3787 The TODO has a scheduled date, with a @code{.+} style repeat interval.
3789 The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by using the
3790 syntax @samp{.+2d/3d}, which says that you want to do the task at least every
3791 three days, but at most every two days.
3793 You must also have state logging for the @code{DONE} state enabled, in order
3794 for historical data to be represented in the consistency graph. If it's not
3795 enabled it's not an error, but the consistency graphs will be largely
3799 To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an
3800 actual habit with some history:
3804 SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d>
3805 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu]
3806 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon]
3807 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat]
3808 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun]
3809 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri]
3810 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue]
3811 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri]
3812 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat]
3813 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed]
3814 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat]
3817 :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36]
3821 What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given by the
3822 @code{SCHEDULED} date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days. If
3823 today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on Oct 17,
3824 after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19,
3825 after four days have elapsed.
3827 What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along with a
3828 consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting that task
3829 done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task was done over the
3830 past three weeks, with colors for each day. The colors used are:
3834 If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day.
3836 If the task could have been done on that day.
3838 If the task was going to be overdue the next day.
3840 If the task was overdue on that day.
3843 In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an asterisk if
3844 the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation mark to show where
3845 the current day falls in the graph.
3847 There are several configuration variables that can be used to change the way
3848 habits are displayed in the agenda.
3851 @item org-habit-graph-column
3852 The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. This will
3853 overwrite any text in that column, so it's a good idea to keep your habits'
3854 titles brief and to the point.
3855 @item org-habit-preceding-days
3856 The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in consistency graphs.
3857 @item org-habit-following-days
3858 The number of days after today that will appear in consistency graphs.
3859 @item org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today
3860 If non-nil, only show habits in today's agenda view. This is set to true by
3864 Lastly, pressing @kbd{K} in the agenda buffer will cause habits to
3865 temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press @kbd{K} again to
3866 bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you have habits
3867 which should only be done in certain contexts, for example.
3869 @node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, Progress logging, TODO Items
3873 If you use Org-mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items that
3874 it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
3875 placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like this
3878 *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
3882 @vindex org-priority-faces
3883 By default, Org-mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
3884 @samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is
3885 treated as priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only in the
3886 agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they have no
3887 inherent meaning to Org-mode. The cookies can be highlighted with special
3888 faces by customizing the variable @code{org-priority-faces}.
3890 Priorities can be attached to any outline tree entries; they do not need
3896 Set the priority of the current headline. The command prompts for a
3897 priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}. When you press
3898 @key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the headline.
3899 The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline and
3900 agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3903 @kindex S-@key{down}
3906 @vindex org-priority-start-cycle-with-default
3907 Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the option
3908 @code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default}.}. Note that these keys are
3909 also used to modify timestamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}). See also
3910 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
3911 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
3914 @vindex org-highest-priority
3915 @vindex org-lowest-priority
3916 @vindex org-default-priority
3917 You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables
3918 @code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
3919 @code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
3920 these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
3921 the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
3924 @cindex #+PRIORITIES
3929 @node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO Items
3930 @section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
3931 @cindex tasks, breaking down
3932 @cindex statistics, for TODO items
3934 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
3935 It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
3936 subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
3937 with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
3938 global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
3939 the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
3940 either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
3941 be updated each time the TODO status of a child changes, or when pressing
3942 @kbd{C-c C-c} on the cookie. For example:
3945 * Organize Party [33%]
3946 ** TODO Call people [1/2]
3950 ** DONE Talk to neighbor
3953 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
3954 If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the meaning of
3955 the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property
3956 @code{COOKIE_DATA} to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve
3959 @vindex org-hierarchical-todo-statistics
3960 If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries in the
3961 subtree (not just direct children), configure the variable
3962 @code{org-hierarchical-todo-statistics}. To do this for a single subtree,
3963 include the word @samp{recursive} into the value of the @code{COOKIE_DATA}
3967 * Parent capturing statistics [2/20]
3969 :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive
3973 If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE
3974 when all children are done, you can use the following setup:
3977 (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
3978 "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
3979 (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
3980 (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
3982 (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
3986 Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
3987 large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
3990 @node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO Items
3994 Every item in a plain list (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a
3995 checkbox by starting it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is
3996 similar to TODO items (@pxref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight.
3997 Checkboxes are not included into the global TODO list, so they are often
3998 great to split a task into a number of simple steps. Or you can use
3999 them in a shopping list. To toggle a checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or
4000 use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's @file{org-mouse.el}).
4002 Here is an example of a checkbox list.
4005 * TODO Organize party [2/4]
4006 - [-] call people [1/3]
4011 - [ ] think about what music to play
4012 - [X] talk to the neighbors
4015 Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
4016 are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
4017 parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
4020 @cindex statistics, for checkboxes
4021 @cindex checkbox statistics
4022 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4023 @vindex org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics
4024 The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are cookies
4025 indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked off,
4026 and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an idea on how
4027 many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The cookies can
4028 be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a plain list item.
4029 Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct children structurally below the
4030 headline/item on which the cookie appears@footnote{Set the variable
4031 @code{org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics} if you want such cookies to
4032 represent the all checkboxes below the cookie, not just the direct
4033 children.}. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either
4034 @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m}
4035 result, as in the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about
4036 the percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
4037 @samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively). In a headline, a cookie can
4038 count either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it
4039 will display whatever was changed last. Set the property @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4040 to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve this issue.
4042 @cindex blocking, of checkboxes
4043 @cindex checkbox blocking
4044 @cindex property, ORDERED
4045 If the current outline node has an @code{ORDERED} property, checkboxes must
4046 be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try to check
4047 off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it.
4049 @noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
4054 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4055 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4059 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4060 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4064 If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
4065 and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix
4066 arg, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region.
4068 If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between
4069 this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree).
4071 If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
4073 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
4075 Insert a new item with a checkbox.
4076 This works only if the cursor is already in a plain list item
4077 (@pxref{Plain lists}).
4080 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4081 @cindex property, ORDERED
4082 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the entry, to toggle if checkboxes must
4083 be checked off in sequence. A property is used for this behavior because
4084 this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag.
4085 However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of this property with a tag
4086 for better visibility, customize the variable
4087 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4090 Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When called with
4091 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox statistic cookies are
4092 updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make
4093 new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. TODO statistics cookies update when
4094 changing TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by
4095 hand, use this command to get things back into sync. Or simply toggle any
4096 entry twice (checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c}).
4099 @node Tags, Properties and Columns, TODO Items, Top
4102 @cindex headline tagging
4103 @cindex matching, tags
4104 @cindex sparse tree, tag based
4106 An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
4107 information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org-mode has extensive
4110 @vindex org-tag-faces
4111 Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
4112 headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
4113 @samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
4114 @samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
4115 Tags will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline.
4116 You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
4117 @code{org-tag-faces}, in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords
4118 (@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
4121 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
4122 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
4123 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
4126 @node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags
4127 @section Tag inheritance
4128 @cindex tag inheritance
4129 @cindex inheritance, of tags
4130 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
4132 @i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
4133 heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
4134 well. For example, in the list
4137 * Meeting with the French group :work:
4138 ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
4139 *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
4143 the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
4144 @samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
4145 explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in
4146 a file should inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical
4147 level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this@footnote{As
4148 with all these in-buffer settings, pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} activates any
4149 changes in the line.}:
4153 #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
4157 @vindex org-use-tag-inheritance
4158 @vindex org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance
4159 To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, or to turn it off entirely, use
4160 the variables @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} and
4161 @code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
4163 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4164 When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
4165 on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
4166 as well@footnote{This is only true if the search does not involve more
4167 complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
4168 of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
4169 match in a subtree, configure the variable
4170 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not recommended).
4172 @node Setting tags, Tag searches, Tag inheritance, Tags
4173 @section Setting tags
4174 @cindex setting tags
4175 @cindex tags, setting
4178 Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
4179 After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
4180 also a special command for inserting tags:
4185 @cindex completion, of tags
4186 @vindex org-tags-column
4187 Enter new tags for the current headline. Org-mode will either offer
4188 completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
4189 below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
4190 to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
4191 tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
4192 things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
4193 demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
4196 When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
4199 @vindex org-tag-alist
4200 Org will support tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
4201 default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
4202 currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
4203 of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
4204 the default tags for a given file with lines like
4208 #+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
4209 #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
4212 If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
4213 variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
4214 in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
4220 @vindex org-tag-persistent-alist
4221 If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in every file,
4222 in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS option lines, then
4223 you may specify a list of tags with the variable
4224 @code{org-tag-persistent-alist}. You may turn this off on a per-file basis
4225 by adding a STARTUP option line to that file:
4231 By default Org-mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
4232 entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
4233 method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
4234 deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
4235 assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this
4236 globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your
4237 @file{.emacs} file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in
4238 different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
4242 (setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
4245 @noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you
4246 can instead set the TAGS option line as:
4249 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
4252 @noindent The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash
4253 window. If you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert
4254 @samp{\n} into the tag list
4257 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p)
4260 @noindent or write them in two lines:
4263 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t)
4264 #+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p)
4268 You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using
4272 #+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
4275 @noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
4276 and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
4278 @noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
4279 these lines to activate any changes.
4282 To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-tags-alist},
4283 you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
4284 of the braces. Similarly, you can use @code{:newline} to indicate a line
4285 break. The previous example would be set globally by the following
4289 (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
4290 ("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
4291 ("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
4293 ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
4296 If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
4297 automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
4298 the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
4299 corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
4300 have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use the following
4305 Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of
4306 tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
4307 exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group.
4310 Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
4311 list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
4314 Clear all tags for this line.
4317 Accept the modified set.
4319 Abort without installing changes.
4321 If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
4323 Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
4324 exception) assign several tags from such a group.
4326 Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
4327 If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
4332 This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
4333 the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
4334 @samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
4335 C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
4336 @samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
4337 alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
4338 @samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
4339 @key{RET} @key{RET}}.
4341 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-single-key
4342 If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to
4343 modify your list of tags, set the variable
4344 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to
4345 press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection---it will immediately exit
4346 after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press
4347 @kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process
4348 (in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c
4349 C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special
4350 window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only
4351 when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
4353 @node Tag searches, , Setting tags, Tags
4354 @section Tag searches
4355 @cindex tag searches
4356 @cindex searching for tags
4358 Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
4359 information into special lists.
4366 Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a
4367 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4370 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files.
4371 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4374 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4375 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4376 only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable
4377 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4380 These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic Boolean logic
4381 like @samp{+boss+urgent-project1}, to find entries with tags @samp{boss} and
4382 @samp{urgent}, but not @samp{project1}, or @samp{Kathy|Sally} to find entries
4383 which are tagged, like @samp{Kathy} or @samp{Sally}. The full syntax of the search
4384 string is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry levels
4385 and properties. For a complete description with many examples, see
4386 @ref{Matching tags and properties}.
4389 @node Properties and Columns, Dates and Times, Tags, Top
4390 @chapter Properties and columns
4393 Properties are a set of key-value pairs associated with an entry. There
4394 are two main applications for properties in Org-mode. First, properties
4395 are like tags, but with a value. Second, you can use properties to
4396 implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. For
4397 an example of the first application, imagine maintaining a file where
4398 you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of
4399 using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, one can use a
4400 property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
4401 values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. For an example of the second
4402 application of properties, imagine keeping track of your music CDs,
4403 where properties could be things such as the album, artist, date of
4404 release, number of tracks, and so on.
4406 Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
4407 (@pxref{Column view}).
4410 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
4411 * Special properties:: Access to other Org-mode features
4412 * Property searches:: Matching property values
4413 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
4414 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
4415 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
4418 @node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and Columns, Properties and Columns
4419 @section Property syntax
4420 @cindex property syntax
4421 @cindex drawer, for properties
4423 Properties are key-value pairs. They need to be inserted into a special
4424 drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property
4425 is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons)
4426 first, and the value after it. Here is an example:
4431 *** Goldberg Variations
4433 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4434 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4436 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4441 You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
4442 by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
4443 @emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
4444 the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
4445 corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
4446 errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
4447 publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
4452 :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
4453 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
4457 If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
4458 file, use a line like
4459 @cindex property, _ALL
4462 #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
4465 @vindex org-global-properties
4466 Property values set with the global variable
4467 @code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
4471 The following commands help to work with properties:
4476 After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
4477 in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
4480 Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
4481 necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
4482 @item M-x org-insert-property-drawer
4483 Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
4484 inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
4485 information like deadlines.
4488 With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
4490 Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
4491 can be inserted using completion.
4492 @kindex S-@key{right}
4493 @kindex S-@key{left}
4494 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
4495 Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
4497 Remove a property from the current entry.
4499 Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
4501 Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
4502 nearest column format definition.
4505 @node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and Columns
4506 @section Special properties
4507 @cindex properties, special
4509 Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org-mode
4510 features, like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in the
4511 previous chapters. This interface exists so that you can include
4512 these states in a column view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in
4513 queries. The following property names are special and should not be
4514 used as keys in the properties drawer:
4516 @cindex property, special, TODO
4517 @cindex property, special, TAGS
4518 @cindex property, special, ALLTAGS
4519 @cindex property, special, CATEGORY
4520 @cindex property, special, PRIORITY
4521 @cindex property, special, DEADLINE
4522 @cindex property, special, SCHEDULED
4523 @cindex property, special, CLOSED
4524 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP
4525 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA
4526 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
4527 @cindex property, special, BLOCKED
4528 @c guessing that ITEM is needed in this area; also, should this list be sorted?
4529 @cindex property, special, ITEM
4531 TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
4532 TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
4533 ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
4534 CATEGORY @r{The category of an entry.}
4535 PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
4536 DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
4537 SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets.}
4538 CLOSED @r{When was this entry closed?}
4539 TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry.}
4540 TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive timestamp in the entry.}
4541 CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
4542 @r{must be run first to compute the values.}
4543 BLOCKED @r{"t" if task is currently blocked by children or siblings}
4544 ITEM @r{The content of the entry.}
4547 @node Property searches, Property inheritance, Special properties, Properties and Columns
4548 @section Property searches
4549 @cindex properties, searching
4550 @cindex searching, of properties
4552 To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
4553 the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}).
4559 Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a
4560 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4563 Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda files.
4564 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4567 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4568 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4569 only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see variable
4570 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4573 The syntax for the search string is described in @ref{Matching tags and
4576 There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
4582 Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
4583 prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
4584 is created with all entries that define this property with the given
4585 value. If you enclose the value into curly braces, it is interpreted as
4586 a regular expression and matched against the property values.
4589 @node Property inheritance, Column view, Property searches, Properties and Columns
4590 @section Property Inheritance
4591 @cindex properties, inheritance
4592 @cindex inheritance, of properties
4594 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
4595 The outline structure of Org-mode documents lends itself for an
4596 inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain
4597 property, the children can inherit this property. Org-mode does not
4598 turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
4599 significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
4600 useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
4601 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t} to make
4602 all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
4603 that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
4604 inherited properties. If a property has the value @samp{nil}, this is
4605 interpreted as an explicit undefine of he property, so that inheritance
4606 search will stop at this value and return @code{nil}.
4608 Org-mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
4609 least for the special applications for which they are used:
4611 @cindex property, COLUMNS
4614 The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
4615 (@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
4616 where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
4617 point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
4618 subtree from where columns view is turned on.
4620 @cindex property, CATEGORY
4621 For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
4622 applies to the entire subtree.
4624 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
4625 For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
4626 location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
4628 @cindex property, LOGGING
4629 The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
4630 subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
4633 @node Column view, Property API, Property inheritance, Properties and Columns
4634 @section Column view
4636 A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
4637 @emph{column view}. In column view, each outline node is turned into a
4638 table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
4639 entries. Org-mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
4640 over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
4641 into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
4642 tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
4643 view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
4644 is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
4645 headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
4646 tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
4647 Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda Views}) where
4648 queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
4651 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
4652 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
4653 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
4656 @node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view
4657 @subsection Defining columns
4658 @cindex column view, for properties
4659 @cindex properties, column view
4661 Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
4662 done by defining a column format line.
4665 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
4666 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
4669 @node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns
4670 @subsubsection Scope of column definitions
4672 To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
4676 #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
4679 To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
4680 @code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
4683 ** Top node for columns view
4685 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
4689 If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
4690 for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
4691 column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
4692 you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
4693 sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
4694 deeper part of the tree.
4696 @node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns
4697 @subsubsection Column attributes
4698 A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
4699 definition looks like this:
4702 %[@var{width}]@var{property}[(@var{title})][@{@var{summary-type}@}]
4706 Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
4707 optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
4710 @var{width} @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
4711 @r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
4712 @var{property} @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
4713 @r{Special properties representing meta data are allowed here}
4714 @r{as well (@pxref{Special properties})}
4715 @var{title} @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the property}
4717 @{@var{summary-type}@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
4718 @r{parent nodes are computed from the children.}
4719 @r{Supported summary types are:}
4720 @{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
4721 @{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
4722 @{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
4723 @{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are hours.}
4724 @{X@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[X]} if all children are @samp{[X]}.}
4725 @{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n/m]}.}
4726 @{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n%]}.}
4727 @{min@} @r{Smallest number in column.}
4728 @{max@} @r{Largest number.}
4729 @{mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of numbers.}
4730 @{:min@} @r{Smallest time value in column.}
4731 @{:max@} @r{Largest time value.}
4732 @{:mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of time values.}
4733 @{@@min@} @r{Minimum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
4734 @{@@max@} @r{Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
4735 @{@@mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
4736 @{est+@} @r{Add low-high estimates.}
4740 Be aware that you can only have one summary type for any property you
4741 include. Subsequent columns referencing the same property will all display the
4742 same summary information.
4744 The @code{est+} summary type requires further explanation. It is used for
4745 combining estimates, expressed as low-high ranges. For example, instead
4746 of estimating a particular task will take 5 days, you might estimate it as
4747 5-6 days if you're fairly confident you know how much woark is required, or
4748 1-10 days if you don't really know what needs to be done. Both ranges
4749 average at 5.5 days, but the first represents a more predictable delivery.
4751 When combining a set of such estimates, simply adding the lows and highs
4752 produces an unrealistically wide result. Instead, @code{est+} adds the
4753 statistical mean and variance of the sub-tasks, generating a final estimate
4754 from the sum. For example, suppose you had ten tasks, each of which was
4755 estimated at 0.5 to 2 days of work. Straight addition produces an estimate
4756 of 5 to 20 days, representing what to expect if everything goes either
4757 extremely well or extremely poorly. In contrast, @code{est+} estimates the
4758 full job more realistically, at 10-15 days.
4760 Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
4764 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line---it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
4765 %10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
4766 :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
4767 :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
4768 :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
4772 The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
4773 item itself, i.e. of the headline. You probably always should start the
4774 column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
4775 create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
4776 @samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
4777 field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
4778 character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
4779 to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
4780 modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
4781 be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
4782 expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
4783 an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
4784 @samp{CLOCKSUM} column is special, it lists the sum of CLOCK intervals
4787 @node Using column view, Capturing column view, Defining columns, Column view
4788 @subsection Using column view
4791 @tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
4794 @vindex org-columns-default-format
4795 Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline in the file,
4796 column view is turned on for the entire file, using the @code{#+COLUMNS}
4797 definition. If the cursor is somewhere inside the outline, this command
4798 searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that
4799 defines a format. When one is found, the column view table is established
4800 for the tree starting at the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:}
4801 property. If no such property is found, the format is taken from the
4802 @code{#+COLUMNS} line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format},
4803 and column view is established for the current entry and its subtree.
4806 Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
4813 @tsubheading{Editing values}
4814 @item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
4815 Move through the column view from field to field.
4816 @kindex S-@key{left}
4817 @kindex S-@key{right}
4818 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
4819 Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
4820 have to have specified allowed values for a property.
4822 Directly select the nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
4826 Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
4829 Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
4830 invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
4831 property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
4832 or fast selection interface will pop up.
4835 When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
4838 View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
4839 the column is smaller than that of the value.
4842 Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
4843 in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is
4844 found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
4845 current column view.
4846 @tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
4850 Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
4851 @kindex S-M-@key{right}
4852 @item S-M-@key{right}
4853 Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
4854 @kindex S-M-@key{left}
4855 @item S-M-@key{left}
4856 Delete the current column.
4859 @node Capturing column view, , Using column view, Column view
4860 @subsection Capturing column view
4862 Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
4863 exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
4864 a @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
4865 of this block looks like this:
4867 @cindex #+BEGIN, columnview
4870 #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
4875 @noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
4879 This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
4880 often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
4881 at a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
4882 capture, you can use 4 values:
4883 @cindex property, ID
4885 local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
4886 global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
4887 "file:@var{path-to-file}"
4888 @r{run column view at the top of this file}
4889 "@var{ID}" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
4890 @r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
4891 @r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy} to create a globally unique ID for}
4892 @r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
4895 When @code{t}, insert an hline after every line. When a number @var{N}, insert
4896 an hline before each headline with level @code{<= @var{N}}.
4898 When set to @code{t}, force column groups to get vertical lines.
4900 When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
4901 @item :skip-empty-rows
4902 When set to @code{t}, skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of the
4903 column view is @code{ITEM}.
4908 The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
4913 Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
4914 for the scope or ID of the view.
4919 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
4920 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
4921 @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u
4922 @item C-u C-c C-x C-u
4923 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
4924 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
4927 You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
4928 instructions in front of the table---these will survive an update of the
4929 block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
4930 actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
4932 An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table is
4933 provided by Eric Schulte's @file{org-collector.el} which is a contributed
4934 package@footnote{Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are
4935 distributed with the main distribution of Org (visit
4936 @uref{http://orgmode.org}).}. It provides a general API to collect
4937 properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp expressions to
4938 process these values before inserting them into a table or a dynamic block.
4940 @node Property API, , Column view, Properties and Columns
4941 @section The Property API
4942 @cindex properties, API
4943 @cindex API, for properties
4945 There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
4946 be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
4947 features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
4950 @node Dates and Times, Capture - Refile - Archive, Properties and Columns, Top
4951 @chapter Dates and times
4957 To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
4958 a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
4959 information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org-mode. This may be a
4960 little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
4961 something was created or last changed. However, in Org-mode this term
4962 is used in a much wider sense.
4965 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
4966 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
4967 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
4968 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
4969 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time if you've been idle
4970 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
4971 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
4975 @node Timestamps, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times, Dates and Times
4976 @section Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling
4978 @cindex ranges, time
4983 A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a range of
4984 times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>} or
4985 @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue
4986 12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is inspired by the standard ISO 8601 date/time
4987 format. To use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time format}.}. A
4988 timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org tree entry.
4989 Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the agenda
4990 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
4993 @item Plain timestamp; Event; Appointment
4995 A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just
4996 like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the
4997 timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry associated with a
4998 plain timestamp will be shown exactly on that date.
5001 * Meet Peter at the movies <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
5002 * Discussion on climate change <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
5005 @item Timestamp with repeater interval
5006 @cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
5007 A timestamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
5008 applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
5009 interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years (y). The
5010 following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
5013 * Pick up Sam at school <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
5016 @item Diary-style sexp entries
5017 For more complex date specifications, Org-mode supports using the
5018 special sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
5019 package. For example
5022 * The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
5023 <%%(diary-float t 4 2)>
5026 @item Time/Date range
5029 Two timestamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
5030 will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
5031 that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
5034 ** Meeting in Amsterdam
5035 <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
5038 @item Inactive timestamp
5039 @cindex timestamp, inactive
5040 @cindex inactive timestamp
5041 Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of
5042 angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that they do
5043 @emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
5046 * Gillian comes late for the fifth time [2006-11-01 Wed]
5051 @node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps, Dates and Times
5052 @section Creating timestamps
5053 @cindex creating timestamps
5054 @cindex timestamps, creating
5056 For Org-mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific
5057 format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct
5063 Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the cursor is
5064 at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
5065 timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
5066 succession, a time range is inserted.
5070 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause
5077 @vindex org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes
5078 Like @kbd{C-c .} and @kbd{C-c !}, but use the alternative format which
5079 contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5
5080 minutes, see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
5084 Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
5088 Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
5089 timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
5094 Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at
5095 point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
5097 @kindex S-@key{left}
5098 @kindex S-@key{right}
5100 @itemx S-@key{right}
5101 Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
5102 shift-selection and related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5105 @kindex S-@key{down}
5108 Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
5109 year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp contains a time range
5110 like @samp{15:30-16:30}, modifying the first time will also shift the second,
5111 shifting the time block with constant length. To change the length, modify
5112 the second time. Note that if the cursor is in a headline and not at a
5113 timestamp, these same keys modify the priority of an item.
5114 (@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and
5115 related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5118 @cindex evaluate time range
5120 Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
5121 With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
5122 the following column).
5127 * The date/time prompt:: How Org-mode helps you entering date and time
5128 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
5131 @node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps
5132 @subsection The date/time prompt
5133 @cindex date, reading in minibuffer
5134 @cindex time, reading in minibuffer
5136 @vindex org-read-date-prefer-future
5137 When Org-mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default
5138 date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific
5139 format. But it will in fact accept any string containing some date and/or
5140 time information, and it is really smart about interpreting your input. You
5141 can, for example, use @kbd{C-y} to paste a (possibly multi-line) string
5142 copied from an email message. Org-mode will find whatever information is in
5143 there and derive anything you have not specified from the @emph{default date
5144 and time}. The default is usually the current date and time, but when
5145 modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a
5146 range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in
5147 information, Org-mode assumes that most of the time you will want to enter a
5148 date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given day/month is
5149 @i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a future date@footnote{See the
5150 variable @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}. You may set that variable to
5151 the symbol @code{time} to even make a time before now shift the date to
5152 tomorrow.}. If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, the
5153 time prompt will show this with @samp{(=>F).}
5155 For example, let's assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
5156 various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org-mode are
5160 3-2-5 --> 2003-02-05
5161 2/5/3 --> 2003-02-05
5162 14 --> @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
5163 12 --> @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
5164 2/5 --> @b{2007}-02-05
5165 Fri --> nearest Friday (default date or later)
5166 sep 15 --> @b{2006}-09-15
5167 feb 15 --> @b{2007}-02-15
5168 sep 12 9 --> 2009-09-12
5169 12:45 --> @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
5170 22 sept 0:34 --> @b{2006}-09-22 0:34
5171 w4 --> ISO week for of the current year @b{2006}
5172 2012 w4 fri --> Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
5173 2012-w04-5 --> Same as above
5176 Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the
5177 @emph{first} thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a
5178 letter ([dwmy]) to indicate change in days, weeks, months, or years. With a
5179 single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a
5180 double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of
5181 a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be
5182 the nth such day. E.g.
5187 +4d --> four days from today
5188 +4 --> same as above
5189 +2w --> two weeks from today
5190 ++5 --> five days from default date
5191 +2tue --> second Tuesday from now.
5194 @vindex parse-time-months
5195 @vindex parse-time-weekdays
5196 The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
5197 you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
5198 the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
5200 You can specify a time range by giving start and end times or by giving a
5201 start time and a duration (in HH:MM format). Use '-' or '--' as the separator
5202 in the former case and use '+' as the separator in the latter case. E.g.
5205 11am-1:15pm --> 11:00-13:15
5206 11am--1:15pm --> same as above
5207 11am+2:15 --> same as above
5210 @cindex calendar, for selecting date
5211 @vindex org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt
5212 Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
5213 you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
5214 @code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
5215 prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
5216 @key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
5217 information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
5218 from the minibuffer:
5225 @kindex S-@key{right}
5226 @kindex S-@key{left}
5227 @kindex S-@key{down}
5229 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
5230 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
5233 @key{RET} @r{Choose date at cursor in calendar.}
5234 mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
5235 S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
5236 S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
5237 M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
5238 > / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
5239 M-v / C-v @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by 3 months.}
5242 @vindex org-read-date-display-live
5243 The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
5244 will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
5245 way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
5246 on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
5247 minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display of with
5248 @code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
5250 @node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps
5251 @subsection Custom time format
5252 @cindex custom date/time format
5253 @cindex time format, custom
5254 @cindex date format, custom
5256 @vindex org-display-custom-times
5257 @vindex org-time-stamp-custom-formats
5258 Org-mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
5259 defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
5260 representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
5261 customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and
5262 @code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
5267 Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
5271 Org-mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
5272 format does not @emph{replace} the default format---instead it is put
5273 @emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
5274 following consequences:
5277 You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before or
5280 The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
5281 each component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
5282 the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
5283 just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
5284 time will be changed by one minute.
5286 If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
5287 will not be overlayed, but remain in the buffer as they were.
5289 When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only
5290 disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
5291 belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
5293 If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you are
5294 using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
5295 format is shorter, things do work as expected.
5299 @node Deadlines and scheduling, Clocking work time, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times
5300 @section Deadlines and scheduling
5302 A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
5306 @cindex DEADLINE keyword
5308 Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
5309 to be finished on that date.
5311 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5312 On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
5313 addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
5314 approaching or missed deadline, starting
5315 @code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
5316 until the entry is marked DONE. An example:
5319 *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
5320 The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
5321 DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
5324 You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
5325 deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
5326 period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}.
5329 @cindex SCHEDULED keyword
5331 Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
5334 @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done
5335 The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
5336 be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE. If you don't like
5337 this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
5338 addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
5339 in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE.
5340 I.e. the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
5343 *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
5344 SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
5348 @b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org-mode should @i{not} be
5349 understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
5350 Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
5351 mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown
5352 on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding by
5353 Org users. In Org-mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
5354 want to start working on an action item.
5357 You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
5358 entries. Org-mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
5359 assumption that the timestamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
5360 the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
5362 @code{<%%(diary-float t 42)>}
5364 in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org-mode does not
5365 know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
5366 late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
5370 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
5371 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
5374 @node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling
5375 @subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
5377 The following commands allow you to quickly insert a deadline or to schedule
5384 Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will happen
5385 in the line directly following the headline. When called with a prefix arg,
5386 an existing deadline will be removed from the entry. Depending on the
5387 variable @code{org-log-redeadline}@footnote{with corresponding
5388 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline},
5389 and @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5391 @c FIXME Any CLOSED timestamp will be removed.????????
5395 Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
5396 happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp
5397 will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove the scheduling
5398 date from the entry. Depending on the variable
5399 @code{org-log-reschedule}@footnote{with corresponding @code{#+STARTUP}
5400 keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline}, and
5401 @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5408 Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked the entry
5409 like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to find an appropriate
5410 date. With the cursor on the selected date, press @kbd{k s} or @kbd{k d} to
5411 schedule the marked item.
5414 @cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
5416 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5417 Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
5418 which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
5419 With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
5420 prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
5421 all deadlines due tomorrow.
5425 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date.
5429 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date.
5432 @node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling
5433 @subsection Repeated tasks
5434 @cindex tasks, repeated
5435 @cindex repeated tasks
5437 Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org-mode helps to
5438 organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
5439 or plain timestamp. In the following example
5441 ** TODO Pay the rent
5442 DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
5445 the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task
5446 has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month starting
5447 from that time. If you need both a repeater and a special warning period in
5448 a deadline entry, the repeater should come first and the warning period last:
5449 @code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
5451 @vindex org-todo-repeat-to-state
5452 Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they are
5453 over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as completed
5454 once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE with the TODO
5455 keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the agenda. The problem
5456 with this is, however, that then also the @emph{next} instance of the
5457 repeated entry will not be active. Org-mode deals with this in the following
5458 way: When you try to mark such an entry DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will
5459 shift the base date of the repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and
5460 immediately set the entry state back to TODO@footnote{In fact, the target
5461 state is taken from, in this sequence, the @code{REPEAT_TO_STATE} property or
5462 the variable @code{org-todo-repeat-to-state}. If neither of these is
5463 specified, the target state defaults to the first state of the TODO state
5464 sequence.}. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would actually
5465 switch the date like this:
5468 ** TODO Pay the rent
5469 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
5472 @vindex org-log-repeat
5473 A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
5474 @code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
5475 @code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
5476 will also be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
5477 a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
5479 As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
5480 visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
5483 With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
5484 month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this
5485 entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
5486 task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
5487 forgot to call you father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
5488 him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
5489 like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
5490 @i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org-mode has
5491 special repeaters markers with @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
5495 DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
5496 Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
5497 but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
5498 the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
5499 and marked it done on Saturday.
5500 ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
5501 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
5502 Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
5506 You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
5507 task---just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same.
5509 An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of a task
5510 subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command @kbd{C-c C-x c} was
5511 created for this purpose, it is described in @ref{Structure editing}.
5514 @node Clocking work time, Resolving idle time, Deadlines and scheduling, Dates and Times
5515 @section Clocking work time
5517 Org-mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a
5518 project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock.
5519 When you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the
5520 clock is stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It
5521 also computes the total time spent on each subtree of a project. And it
5522 remembers a history or tasks recently clocked, to that you can jump quickly
5523 between a number of tasks absorbing your time.
5525 To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use
5527 (setq org-clock-persist 'history)
5528 (org-clock-persistence-insinuate)
5530 When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete
5531 clock@footnote{To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked
5532 on this task while outside Emacs, use @code{(setq org-clock-persist t)}.}
5533 will be found (@pxref{Resolving idle time}) and you will be prompted about
5539 @vindex org-clock-into-drawer
5540 Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
5541 keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
5542 this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
5543 @code{:LOGBOOK:} drawer (see also the variable
5544 @code{org-clock-into-drawer}). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
5545 select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
5546 C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task.
5547 The default task will always be available when selecting a clocking task,
5548 with letter @kbd{d}.@*
5549 @cindex property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL
5550 @cindex property: LAST_REPEAT
5551 @vindex org-clock-modeline-total
5552 While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in the mode
5553 line, along with the title of the task. The clock time shown will be all
5554 time ever clocked for this task and its children. If the task has an effort
5555 estimate (@pxref{Effort estimates}), the mode line displays the current
5556 clocking time against it@footnote{To add an effort estimate ``on the fly'',
5557 hook a function doing this to @code{org-clock-in-prepare-hook}.} If the task
5558 is a repeating one (@pxref{Repeated tasks}), only the time since the last
5559 reset of the task @footnote{as recorded by the @code{LAST_REPEAT} property}
5560 will be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised with
5561 the @code{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL} property. It may have the values
5562 @code{current} to show only the current clocking instance, @code{today} to
5563 show all time clocked on this tasks today (see also the variable
5564 @code{org-extend-today-until}), @code{all} to include all time, or
5565 @code{auto} which is the default@footnote{See also the variable
5566 @code{org-clock-modeline-total}.}.@* Clicking with @kbd{mouse-1} onto the
5567 mode line entry will pop up a menu with clocking options.
5570 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
5571 Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same
5572 location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
5573 the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
5574 HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
5575 possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
5576 timestamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
5577 @code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
5580 Update the effort estimate for the current clock task.
5583 @item C-c C-y @ @ @r{or}@ @ C-c C-c
5584 Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. This
5585 is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If you change
5586 them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
5589 Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
5590 if it is running in this same item.
5593 Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
5594 mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
5597 Jump to the headline of the currently clocked in task. With a @kbd{C-u}
5598 prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked tasks.
5601 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
5602 Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This
5603 puts overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time
5604 recorded under that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You
5605 can use visibility cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear
5606 when you change the buffer (see variable
5607 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press @kbd{C-c C-c}.
5610 Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
5611 report as an Org-mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
5612 at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
5613 argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
5615 @cindex #+BEGIN, clocktable
5617 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
5621 If such a block already exists at point, its content is replaced by the
5622 new table. The @samp{BEGIN} line can specify options:
5624 :maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
5625 :emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items.}
5626 :scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
5627 nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
5628 file @r{the full current buffer}
5629 subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
5630 tree@var{N} @r{the surrounding level @var{N} tree, for example @code{tree3}}
5631 tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
5632 agenda @r{all agenda files}
5633 ("file"..) @r{scan these files}
5634 file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
5635 agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
5636 :block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
5637 @r{absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
5639 2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
5640 2007-12 @r{December 2007}
5641 2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
5642 2007 @r{the year 2007}
5643 today, yesterday, today-@var{N} @r{a relative day}
5644 thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-@var{N} @r{a relative week}
5645 thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-@var{N} @r{a relative month}
5646 thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-@var{N} @r{a relative year}
5647 @r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
5648 :tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times.}
5649 :tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times.}
5650 :step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
5651 @r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
5652 :stepskip0 @r{Don't show steps that have zero time}
5653 :tags @r{A tags match to select entries that should contribute}
5654 :link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins.}
5655 :formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
5656 @r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds a column with % time.}
5657 @r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula.}
5658 @r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
5659 :timestamp @r{A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED,}
5660 @r{DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order.}
5662 To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
5663 day, you could write
5665 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
5669 and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
5670 parameters must be specified in a single line---the line is broken here
5671 only to fit it into the manual.}
5673 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
5674 :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
5677 A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
5679 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
5686 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5687 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5688 @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u
5689 @item C-u C-c C-x C-u
5690 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5691 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
5692 @kindex S-@key{left}
5693 @kindex S-@key{right}
5695 @itemx S-@key{right}
5696 Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
5697 needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
5698 @code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
5701 The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in
5702 the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been
5703 worked on or closed during a day.
5705 @node Resolving idle time, Effort estimates, Clocking work time, Dates and Times
5706 @section Resolving idle time
5707 @cindex resolve idle time
5709 @cindex idle, resolve, dangling
5710 If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your
5711 computer---perhaps to take a phone call---you often need to ``resolve'' the
5712 time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or
5713 applying it to another one.
5715 @vindex org-clock-idle-time
5716 By customizing the variable @code{org-clock-idle-time} to some integer, such
5717 as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your computer after
5718 being idle for that many minutes@footnote{On computers using Mac OS X,
5719 idleness is based on actual user idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For
5720 X11, you can install a utility program @file{x11idle.c}, available in the
5721 UTILITIES directory of the Org git distribution, to get the same general
5722 treatment of idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to Emacs idle time
5723 only.}, and ask what you want to do with the idle time. There will be a
5724 question waiting for you when you get back, indicating how much idle time has
5725 passed (constantly updated with the current amount), as well as a set of
5726 choices to correct the discrepancy:
5730 To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press @kbd{k}. Org
5731 will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press @key{RET} to keep them all,
5732 effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep that many minutes.
5734 If you use the shift key and press @kbd{K}, it will keep however many minutes
5735 you request and then immediately clock out of that task. If you keep all of
5736 the minutes, this is the same as just clocking out of the current task.
5738 To keep none of the minutes, use @kbd{s} to subtract all the away time from
5739 the clock, and then check back in from the moment you returned.
5741 To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the away time,
5742 use the shift key and press @kbd{S}. Remember that using shift will always
5743 leave you clocked out, no matter which option you choose.
5745 To cancel the clock altogether, use @kbd{C}. Note that if instead of
5746 canceling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock amount is less
5747 than a minute, the clock will still be canceled rather than clutter up the
5748 log with an empty entry.
5751 What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and now
5752 want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task immediately
5753 after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have subtracted time ``on
5754 the books'', so to speak, and will ask if you want to apply those minutes to
5755 the next task you clock in on.
5757 There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. Say you
5758 were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased a mouse who
5759 scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! You suddenly
5760 lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still have your recent Org
5761 mode changes, including your last clock in.
5763 If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you have a
5764 dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last session. Using
5765 that clock's starting time as the beginning of the unaccounted-for period,
5766 Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. The logic and behavior is
5767 identical to dealing with away time due to idleness, it's just happening due
5768 to a recovery event rather than a set amount of idle time.
5770 You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for dangling
5771 clocks at any time using @kbd{M-x org-resolve-clocks}.
5773 @node Effort estimates, Relative timer, Resolving idle time, Dates and Times
5774 @section Effort estimates
5775 @cindex effort estimates
5777 @cindex property, Effort
5778 @vindex org-effort-property
5779 If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
5780 produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
5781 assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
5782 may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a
5783 great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a
5784 special property @samp{Effort}@footnote{You may change the property being
5785 used with the variable @code{org-effort-property}.}. You can set the effort
5786 for an entry with the following commands:
5791 Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric prefix
5792 argument, set it to the NTH allowed value (see below). This command is also
5793 accessible from the agenda with the @kbd{e} key.
5796 Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked.
5799 Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column view
5800 (@pxref{Column view}). You should start by setting up discrete values for
5801 effort estimates, and a @code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values
5802 together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For a specific
5806 #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00 8:00
5807 #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
5811 @vindex org-global-properties
5812 @vindex org-columns-default-format
5813 or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
5814 variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
5815 In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
5816 setup may be advised.
5818 The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
5819 mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
5820 value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
5821 In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
5823 @vindex org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum
5824 If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
5825 will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
5826 the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
5827 column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
5828 an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
5829 option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
5830 appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
5831 then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
5833 Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
5834 with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
5835 these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
5836 down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
5838 @node Relative timer, , Effort estimates, Dates and Times
5839 @section Taking notes with a relative timer
5840 @cindex relative timer
5842 When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it can
5843 be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org provides
5844 such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
5849 Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the
5850 timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the timer is
5854 Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix
5855 argument, first reset the timer to 0.
5858 Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
5862 Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused.
5863 @c removed the sentence because it is redundant to the following item
5864 @kindex C-u C-c C-x ,
5866 Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the
5867 old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.
5870 Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By default, the
5871 timer is reset to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, reset the timer to
5872 specific starting offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
5873 default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this can be used to
5874 restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double
5875 prefix argument @kbd{C-u C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region
5876 by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was
5877 not started at exactly the right moment.
5880 @node Capture - Refile - Archive, Agenda Views, Dates and Times, Top
5881 @chapter Capture - Refile - Archive
5884 An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
5885 capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
5886 Org does this using a process called @i{capture}. It also can store files
5887 related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory. Once in the
5888 system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving completed project
5889 trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and fast.
5892 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
5893 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
5894 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
5895 * Protocols:: External (e.g. Browser) access to Emacs and Org
5896 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
5897 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
5900 @node Capture, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive, Capture - Refile - Archive
5904 Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired by John Wiegley
5905 excellent remember package. Up to version 6.36 Org used a special setup
5906 for @file{remember.el}. @file{org-remember.el} is still part of Org-mode for
5907 backward compatibility with existing setups. You can find the documentation
5908 for org-remember at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-remember.pdf}.
5910 The new capturing setup described here is preferred and should be used by new
5911 users. To convert your @code{org-remember-templates}, run the command
5913 @kbd{M-x org-capture-import-remember-templates @key{RET}}
5915 @noindent and then customize the new variable with @kbd{M-x
5916 customize-variable org-capture-templates}, check the result, and save the
5917 customization. You can then use both remember and capture until
5918 you are familiar with the new mechanism.
5920 Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of your work
5921 flow. The basic process of capturing is very similar to remember, but Org
5922 does enhance it with templates and more.
5925 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
5926 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
5927 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
5930 @node Setting up capture, Using capture, Capture, Capture
5931 @subsection Setting up capture
5933 The following customization sets a default target file for notes, and defines
5934 a global key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c c} is only a
5935 suggestion.} for capturing new material.
5937 @vindex org-default-notes-file
5939 (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
5940 (define-key global-map "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
5943 @node Using capture, Capture templates, Setting up capture, Capture
5944 @subsection Using capture
5949 Call the command @code{org-capture}. If you have templates defined
5950 @pxref{Capture templates}, it will offer these templates for selection or use
5951 a new Org outline node as the default template. It will insert the template
5952 into the target file and switch to an indirect buffer narrowed to this new
5953 node. You may then insert the information you want.
5957 Once you have finished entering information into the capture buffer,
5958 @kbd{C-c C-c} will return you to the window configuration before the capture
5959 process, so that you can resume your work without further distraction.
5963 Finalize the capture process by refiling (@pxref{Refiling notes}) the note to
5968 Abort the capture process and return to the previous state.
5971 You can also call @code{org-capture} in a special way from the agenda, using
5972 the @kbd{k c} key combination. With this access, any timestamps inserted by
5973 the selected capture template will default to the cursor date in the agenda,
5974 rather than to the current date.
5976 @node Capture templates, , Using capture, Capture
5977 @subsection Capture templates
5978 @cindex templates, for Capture
5980 You can use templates for different types of capture items, and
5981 for different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates is
5982 through the customize interface.
5987 Customize the variable @code{org-capture-templates}.
5990 Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's look at
5991 an example. Say you would like to use one template to create general TODO
5992 entries, and you want to put these entries under the heading @samp{Tasks} in
5993 your file @file{~/org/gtd.org}. Also, a date tree in the file
5994 @file{journal.org} should capture journal entries. A possible configuration
5998 (setq org-capture-templates
5999 '(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks")
6000 "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a")
6001 ("j" "Journal" entry (file+datetree "~/org/journal.org")
6002 "* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a")))
6005 @noindent If you then press @kbd{C-c c t}, Org will prepare the template
6009 [[file:@var{link to where you initiated capture}]]
6013 During expansion of the template, @code{%a} has been replaced by a link to
6014 the location from where you called the capture command. This can be
6015 extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You fill in
6016 the task definition, press @code{C-c C-c} and Org returns you to the same
6017 place where you started the capture process.
6021 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
6022 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
6025 @node Template elements, Template expansion, Capture templates, Capture templates
6026 @subsubsection Template elements
6028 Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in
6029 @code{org-capture-templates} is a list with the following items:
6033 The keys that will select the template, as a string, characters
6034 only, for example @code{"a"} for a template to be selected with a
6035 single key, or @code{"bt"} for selection with two keys. When using
6036 several keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential
6037 in the list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the
6038 prefix key, for example
6040 ("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy")
6042 @noindent If you do not define a template for the @kbd{C} key, this key will
6043 be used to open the customize buffer for this complex variable.
6046 A short string describing the template, which will be shown during
6050 The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are:
6053 An Org-mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the child of the
6054 target entry or as a top-level entry. The target file should be an Org-mode
6057 A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the target
6058 location. Again the target file should be an Org file.
6060 A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item by the
6063 a new line in the first table at the target location. Where exactly the
6064 line will be inserted depends on the properties @code{:prepend} and
6065 @code{:table-line-pos} (see below).
6067 Text to be inserted as it is.
6071 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6072 Specification of where the captured item should be placed. In Org-mode
6073 files, targets usually define a node. Entries will become children of this
6074 node, other types will be added to the table or list in the body of this
6075 node. Most target specifications contain a file name. If that file name is
6076 the empty string, it defaults to @code{org-default-notes-file}.
6080 @item (file "path/to/file")
6081 Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file.
6083 @item (id "id of existing org entry")
6084 Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry.
6086 @item (file+headline "path/to/file" "node headline")
6087 Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the file.
6089 @item (file+olp "path/to/file" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)
6090 For non-unique headings, the full path is safer.
6092 @item (file+regexp "path/to/file" "regexp to find location")
6093 Use a regular expression to position the cursor.
6095 @item (file+datetree "path/to/file")
6096 Will create a heading in a date tree.
6098 @item (file+function "path/to/file" function-finding-location)
6099 A function to find the right location in the file.
6102 File to the entry that is currently being clocked.
6104 @item (function function-finding-location)
6105 Most general way, write your own function to find both
6110 The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this empty, an
6111 appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise this is a string with
6112 escape codes, which will be replaced depending on time and context of the
6113 capture call. The string with escapes may be loaded from a template file,
6114 using the special syntax @code{(file "path/to/template")}. See below for
6118 The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options.
6119 Recognized properties are:
6122 Normally new captured information will be appended at
6123 the target location (last child, last table line, last list item...).
6124 Setting this property will change that.
6126 @item :immediate-finish
6127 When set, do not offer to edit the information, just
6128 file it away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs
6129 information that can be added automatically.
6132 Set this to the number of lines to insert
6133 before and after the new item. Default 0, only common other value is 1.
6136 Start the clock in this item.
6139 If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that clock when finished
6143 Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer. Default is to
6144 narrow it so that you only see the new material.
6148 @node Template expansion, , Template elements, Capture templates
6149 @subsubsection Template expansion
6151 In the template itself, special @kbd{%}-escapes@footnote{If you need one of
6152 these sequences literally, escape the @kbd{%} with a backslash.} allow
6153 dynamic insertion of content:
6155 @comment SJE: should these sentences terminate in period?
6157 %^@{@var{prompt}@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
6158 @r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
6159 @r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}}
6160 @r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
6161 %a @r{annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}}
6162 %A @r{like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part}
6163 %i @r{initial content, the region when capture is called while the}
6164 @r{region is active.}
6165 @r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
6166 %t @r{timestamp, date only}
6167 %T @r{timestamp with date and time}
6168 %u, %U @r{like the above, but inactive timestamps}
6169 %^t @r{like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}}
6170 @r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}}
6171 %n @r{user name (taken from @code{user-full-name})}
6172 %c @r{Current kill ring head.}
6173 %x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
6174 %^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
6175 %^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
6176 %k @r{title of the currently clocked task}
6177 %K @r{link to the currently clocked task}
6178 %^g @r{prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
6179 %^G @r{prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
6180 %^@{@var{prop}@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @var{prop}}
6181 %:keyword @r{specific information for certain link types, see below}
6182 %[@var{file}] @r{insert the contents of the file given by @var{file}}
6183 %(@var{sexp}) @r{evaluate Elisp @var{sexp} and replace with the result}
6187 For specific link types, the following keywords will be
6188 defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
6189 hyperlink types}), any property you store with
6190 @code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in capture templates in a
6193 @vindex org-from-is-user-regexp
6195 Link type | Available keywords
6196 -------------------+----------------------------------------------
6197 bbdb | %:name %:company
6198 irc | %:server %:port %:nick
6199 vm, wl, mh, mew, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
6200 | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
6201 | %:to %:toname %:toaddress
6202 | %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
6203 gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
6205 info | %:file %:node
6210 To place the cursor after template expansion use:
6213 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6217 @node Attachments, RSS Feeds, Capture, Capture - Refile - Archive
6218 @section Attachments
6221 @vindex org-attach-directory
6222 It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
6223 Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
6224 Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can establish associations with
6225 files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
6226 source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
6227 which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
6228 uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
6229 located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
6230 your Org file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org files from one
6231 directory to another, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
6232 to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
6233 @code{git init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
6234 The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
6236 In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a directory of your
6237 choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the attachment
6238 directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the same attached
6241 @noindent The following commands deal with attachments:
6247 The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
6248 keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must press an additional key
6249 to select a command:
6254 @vindex org-attach-method
6255 Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
6256 will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
6257 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6263 Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
6264 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6268 Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
6272 Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
6273 attachments yourself.
6277 @vindex org-file-apps
6278 Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one, prompt for a
6279 file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
6280 For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks
6281 (@pxref{Handling links}).
6285 Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
6289 Open the current task's attachment directory.
6293 Also open the directory, but force using @command{dired} in Emacs.
6297 Select and delete a single attachment.
6301 Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
6302 @command{dired} and delete from there.
6306 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR
6307 Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by
6308 putting the directory path into the @code{ATTACH_DIR} property.
6312 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT
6313 Set the @code{ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT} property, so that children will use the
6314 same directory for attachments as the parent does.
6318 @node RSS Feeds, Protocols, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive
6323 Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds and
6324 Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new podcast in a
6325 podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based note-creating service on the
6326 web to import tasks into Org. To access feeds, configure the variable
6327 @code{org-feed-alist}. The docstring of this variable has detailed
6328 information. Here is just an example:
6331 (setq org-feed-alist
6333 "http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot"
6334 "~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries")))
6338 will configure that new items from the feed provided by
6339 @code{rss.slashdot.org} will result in new entries in the file
6340 @file{~/org/feeds.org} under the heading @samp{Slashdot Entries}, whenever
6341 the following command is used:
6346 Collect items from the feeds configured in @code{org-feed-alist} and act upon
6350 Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed.
6353 Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer @samp{FEEDSTATUS} in which
6354 it will store information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid
6355 adding the same item several times. You should add @samp{FEEDSTATUS} to the
6356 list of drawers in that file:
6359 #+DRAWERS: LOGBOOK PROPERTIES FEEDSTATUS
6362 For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see
6363 @file{org-feed.el} and the docstring of @code{org-feed-alist}.
6365 @node Protocols, Refiling notes, RSS Feeds, Capture - Refile - Archive
6366 @section Protocols for external access
6367 @cindex protocols, for external access
6370 You can set up Org for handling protocol calls from outside applications that
6371 are passed to Emacs through the @file{emacsserver}. For example, you can
6372 configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link to the current page to
6373 Org and create a note from it using capture (@pxref{Capture}). Or you
6374 could create a bookmark that will tell Emacs to open the local source file of
6375 a remote website you are looking at with the browser. See
6376 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.php} for detailed
6377 documentation and setup instructions.
6379 @node Refiling notes, Archiving, Protocols, Capture - Refile - Archive
6380 @section Refiling notes
6381 @cindex refiling notes
6383 When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile some of the entries
6384 into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting, finding the
6385 right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome. To simplify this
6386 process, you can use the following special command:
6391 @vindex org-reverse-note-order
6392 @vindex org-refile-targets
6393 @vindex org-refile-use-outline-path
6394 @vindex org-outline-path-complete-in-steps
6395 @vindex org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes
6396 @vindex org-log-refile
6397 @vindex org-refile-use-cache
6398 Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
6399 for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
6400 all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
6401 Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
6403 By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
6404 targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
6405 See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
6406 select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
6407 the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
6408 @code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}. If you would like to be able to
6409 create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly, check the
6410 variable @code{org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes}.
6411 When the variable @code{org-log-refile}@footnote{with corresponding
6412 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logrefile}, @code{lognoterefile},
6413 and @code{nologrefile}} is set, a time stamp or a note will be
6414 recorded when an entry has been refiled.
6417 Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
6418 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-w
6419 @item C-u C-u C-c C-w
6420 Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
6422 Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked.
6423 @item C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w
6424 Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned on by
6425 setting @code{org-refile-use-cache}. To make the command seen new possible
6426 targets, you have to clear the cache with this command.
6429 @node Archiving, , Refiling notes, Capture - Refile - Archive
6433 When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
6434 to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
6435 agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and global
6436 searches like the construction of agenda views fast.
6441 @vindex org-archive-default-command
6442 Archive the current entry using the command specified in the variable
6443 @code{org-archive-default-command}.
6447 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
6448 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
6451 @node Moving subtrees, Internal archiving, Archiving, Archiving
6452 @subsection Moving a tree to the archive file
6453 @cindex external archiving
6455 The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another file,
6461 @item C-c C-x C-s@ @r{or short} @ C-c $
6462 @vindex org-archive-location
6463 Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
6464 given by @code{org-archive-location}.
6465 @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-s
6466 @item C-u C-c C-x C-s
6467 Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
6468 the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
6469 If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
6470 location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
6471 is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
6474 @cindex archive locations
6475 The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
6476 current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
6477 current file name. For information and examples on how to change this,
6478 see the documentation string of the variable
6479 @code{org-archive-location}. There is also an in-buffer option for
6480 setting this variable, for example@footnote{For backward compatibility,
6481 the following also works: If there are several such lines in a file,
6482 each specifies the archive location for the text below it. The first
6483 such line also applies to any text before its definition. However,
6484 using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is incompatible
6485 with the outline structure of the document. The correct method for
6486 setting multiple archive locations in a buffer is using properties.}:
6490 #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
6493 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
6495 If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
6496 or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
6497 location as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
6499 @vindex org-archive-save-context-info
6500 When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
6501 record context information like the file from where the entry came, its
6502 outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
6503 @code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
6507 @node Internal archiving, , Moving subtrees, Archiving
6508 @subsection Internal archiving
6510 If you want to just switch off (for agenda views) certain subtrees without
6511 moving them to a different file, you can use the @code{ARCHIVE tag}.
6513 A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at
6514 its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
6517 @vindex org-cycle-open-archived-trees
6518 It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
6519 command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
6520 subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
6521 @code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
6522 @code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
6524 @vindex org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees
6525 During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
6526 archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
6527 @code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
6529 @vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
6530 During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda Views}), the content of
6531 archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
6532 @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
6533 be included. In the agenda you can press @kbd{v a} to get archives
6534 temporarily included.
6536 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
6537 Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
6538 is. Configure the details using the variable
6539 @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
6541 @vindex org-columns-skip-archived-trees
6542 Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable
6543 @code{org-columns-skip-archived-trees} is configured to @code{nil}.
6546 The following commands help manage the ARCHIVE tag:
6551 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
6552 the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
6554 @kindex C-u C-c C-x a
6556 Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
6557 To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
6558 found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
6559 cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
6560 level 1 trees will be checked.
6563 Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
6566 Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
6567 the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}. The
6568 entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way retains a lot of its
6569 original context, including inherited tags and approximate position in the
6574 @node Agenda Views, Markup, Capture - Refile - Archive, Top
6575 @chapter Agenda views
6576 @cindex agenda views
6578 Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
6579 tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
6580 files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
6581 important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
6582 sorted and displayed in an organized way.
6584 Org can select items based on various criteria and display them
6585 in a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
6589 an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
6592 a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
6595 a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, and
6596 TODO state associated with them,
6598 a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org file,
6599 in time-sorted view,
6601 a @emph{text search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
6602 that contain specified keywords,
6604 a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
6607 @emph{custom views} that are special searches and combinations of different
6612 The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
6613 buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
6614 corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
6615 edit these files remotely.
6617 @vindex org-agenda-window-setup
6618 @vindex org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit
6619 Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
6620 window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
6621 @code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
6622 @code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
6625 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
6626 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
6627 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
6628 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
6629 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
6630 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
6631 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
6632 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
6635 @node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views, Agenda Views
6636 @section Agenda files
6637 @cindex agenda files
6638 @cindex files for agenda
6640 @vindex org-agenda-files
6641 The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
6642 files}, the files listed in the variable
6643 @code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
6644 list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
6645 maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
6646 all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
6649 Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should
6650 be put into the list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
6651 @kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
6652 the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
6653 dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
6654 the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
6656 @cindex files, adding to agenda list
6660 Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
6661 the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
6662 the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
6665 Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
6670 Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
6671 @kindex M-x org-iswitchb
6672 @item M-x org-iswitchb
6673 Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
6678 The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
6679 to visit any of them.
6681 If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in
6682 this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree in a
6683 file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
6684 you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
6685 (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
6686 extended period, use the following commands:
6691 Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
6692 prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
6693 the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
6694 effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
6695 or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
6696 agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
6699 Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
6703 When working with @file{speedbar.el}, you can use the following commands in
6707 @item < @r{in the speedbar frame}
6708 Permanently restrict the agenda to the item---either an Org file or a subtree
6709 in such a file---at the cursor in the Speedbar frame.
6710 If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
6713 @item > @r{in the speedbar frame}
6714 Lift the restriction.
6717 @node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda Views
6718 @section The agenda dispatcher
6719 @cindex agenda dispatcher
6720 @cindex dispatching agenda commands
6721 The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a
6722 global key---for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Installation}). In the
6723 following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
6724 is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
6725 pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
6726 command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
6729 Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
6731 Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
6733 Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
6734 tags and properties}).
6736 Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}).
6738 Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
6739 and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
6741 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
6742 Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
6743 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}. This
6744 uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
6745 used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
6748 Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
6750 Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
6751 compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
6752 buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
6753 selecting the command.
6755 If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
6756 the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
6757 backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
6758 current region/subtree.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
6759 character selecting the command.
6762 You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
6763 dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
6764 possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
6765 blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
6766 a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
6768 @node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views
6769 @section The built-in agenda views
6771 In this section we describe the built-in views.
6774 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
6775 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
6776 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
6777 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
6778 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
6779 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
6782 @node Weekly/daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views
6783 @subsection The weekly/daily agenda
6785 @cindex weekly agenda
6786 @cindex daily agenda
6788 The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
6789 paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
6792 @cindex org-agenda, command
6795 @vindex org-agenda-ndays
6796 Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. The agenda
6797 shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
6798 compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
6799 listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
6800 list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
6801 C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed (see also the
6802 variable @code{org-agenda-ndays})
6805 Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
6806 change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
6807 The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
6810 @subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
6811 @cindex calendar integration
6812 @cindex diary integration
6814 Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
6815 calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
6816 countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
6817 anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
6818 (weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
6819 Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
6822 In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org-mode's
6823 agenda, you only need to customize the variable
6826 (setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
6829 @noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
6830 entries including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the
6831 agenda buffer created by Org-mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
6832 @key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
6833 file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
6834 insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
6835 well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
6836 Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
6837 calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
6838 between calendar and agenda.
6840 If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
6841 faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
6842 the entries into an Org file. Org-mode evaluates diary-style sexp
6843 entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
6844 creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
6845 the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example,
6846 the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
6847 will be made in the agenda:
6850 * Birthdays and similar stuff
6852 %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
6854 %%(diary-anniversary 5 14 1956)@footnote{Note that the order of the arguments (month, day, year) depends on the setting of @code{calendar-date-style}.} Arthur Dent is %d years old
6855 %%(diary-anniversary 10 2 1869) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
6858 @subsubheading Anniversaries from BBDB
6859 @cindex BBDB, anniversaries
6860 @cindex anniversaries, from BBDB
6862 If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you will
6863 very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a
6864 separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB
6865 anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the
6866 following to one your your agenda files:
6873 %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries)
6876 You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. Basically,
6877 you need to press @kbd{C-o anniversary @key{RET}} with the cursor in a BBDB
6878 record and then add the date in the format @code{YYYY-MM-DD}, followed by a
6879 space and the class of the anniversary (@samp{birthday} or @samp{wedding}, or
6880 a format string). If you omit the class, it will default to @samp{birthday}.
6881 Here are a few examples, the header for the file @file{org-bbdb.el} contains
6882 more detailed information.
6887 2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org-mode, %d years ago
6890 After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an Emacs
6891 session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org updates its
6892 hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be very fast---much
6893 faster in fact than a long list of @samp{%%(diary-anniversary)} entries
6894 in an Org or Diary file.
6896 @subsubheading Appointment reminders
6897 @cindex @file{appt.el}
6898 @cindex appointment reminders
6900 Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add all
6901 the appointments of your agenda files, use the command
6902 @code{org-agenda-to-appt}. This command also lets you filter through the
6903 list of your appointments and add only those belonging to a specific category
6904 or matching a regular expression. See the docstring for details.
6906 @node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/daily agenda, Built-in agenda views
6907 @subsection The global TODO list
6908 @cindex global TODO list
6909 @cindex TODO list, global
6911 The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and
6912 collected into a single place.
6917 Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all agenda
6918 files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. By default, this lists
6919 items with a state the is not a DONE state. The buffer is in
6920 @code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate the TODO
6921 entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
6924 @cindex TODO keyword matching
6925 @vindex org-todo-keywords
6926 Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You can
6927 also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. You are
6928 prompted for a keyword, and you may also specify several keywords by
6929 separating them with @samp{|} as the boolean OR operator. With a numeric
6930 prefix, the nth keyword in @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
6932 The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
6933 a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
6934 for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
6935 keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
6936 Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
6937 search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
6940 Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
6941 TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
6942 TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
6944 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
6945 Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
6946 keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
6950 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled
6951 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines
6952 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date
6953 Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for execution or
6954 have a @emph{deadline} (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}.
6955 Configure the variables @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled},
6956 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines}, and/or
6957 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date} to exclude such items from the
6960 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
6961 TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
6962 such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
6963 and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
6964 @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
6967 @node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views
6968 @subsection Matching tags and properties
6969 @cindex matching, of tags
6970 @cindex matching, of properties
6974 If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags} (@pxref{Tags}),
6975 or have properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), you can select headlines
6976 based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda buffer. The match
6977 syntax described here also applies when creating sparse trees with @kbd{C-c /
6983 Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
6984 command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
6985 expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
6986 @samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
6987 define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
6990 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
6991 @vindex org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options
6992 Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items in a
6993 not-DONE state and force checking subitems (see variable
6994 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). To exclude scheduled/deadline items,
6995 see the variable @code{org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options}. Matching
6996 specific TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see
7000 The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
7003 @subsubheading Match syntax
7005 @cindex Boolean logic, for tag/property searches
7006 A search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and @samp{|} for
7007 OR. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}. Parentheses are currently
7008 not implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular
7009 expression matching tags, or an expression like @code{PROPERTY OPERATOR
7010 VALUE} with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each element
7011 may be preceded by @samp{-}, to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic
7012 sugar for positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when
7013 @samp{+} or @samp{-} is present. Here are some examples, using only tags.
7017 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
7020 Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
7021 @item work|laptop+night
7022 Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
7026 @cindex regular expressions, with tags search
7027 Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed in curly
7028 braces. For example,
7029 @samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
7030 @samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}.
7032 @cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
7033 @cindex level, require for tags/property match
7034 @cindex category, require for tags/property match
7035 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
7036 You may also test for properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) at the same
7037 time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or special
7038 properties that represent other metadata (@pxref{Special properties}). For
7039 example, the ``property'' @code{TODO} represents the TODO keyword of the
7040 entry. Or, the ``property'' @code{LEVEL} represents the level of an entry.
7041 So a search @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"} lists all level three headlines
7042 that have the tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword
7043 DONE. In buffers with @code{org-odd-levels-only} set, @samp{LEVEL} does not
7044 count the number of stars, but @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars etc.
7046 Here are more examples:
7048 @item work+TODO="WAITING"
7049 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
7050 keyword @samp{WAITING}.
7051 @item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
7052 Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
7055 When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used to test
7056 the value of a property. Here is a complex example:
7059 +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
7060 +With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
7064 The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
7067 If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
7068 and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
7069 @samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
7071 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes,
7072 a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
7074 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes @emph{and} angular
7075 brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
7076 assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
7077 comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
7078 are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
7079 @code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e. without a time
7080 specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
7081 @code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
7082 respectively, can be used.
7084 If the comparison value is enclosed
7085 in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
7086 regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
7090 So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
7091 not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
7092 @samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
7093 property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
7094 matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
7095 on or after October 11, 2008.
7097 Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast. Accessing any
7098 other properties will slow down the search. However, once you have paid the
7099 price by accessing one property, testing additional properties is cheap
7102 You can configure Org-mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
7103 beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
7104 inheritance}, for details.
7106 For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also a
7107 different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate the
7108 tags/property part of the search string (which may include several terms
7109 connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then specify a Boolean
7110 expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that for
7111 tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive selection on
7112 several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with boolean AND.
7113 However, @emph{negative selection} combined with AND can be meaningful. To
7114 make sure that only lines are checked that actually have any TODO keyword
7115 (resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M}, or equivalently start the TODO
7116 part after the slash with @samp{!}. Using @kbd{C-c a M} or @samp{/!} will
7117 not match TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples:
7121 Same as @samp{work+TODO="WAITING"}
7122 @item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
7123 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
7125 @item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
7126 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
7130 @node Timeline, Search view, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views
7131 @subsection Timeline for a single file
7132 @cindex timeline, single file
7133 @cindex time-sorted view
7135 The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org-mode
7136 file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is
7137 to give an overview over events in a project.
7142 Show a time-sorted view of the Org file, with all time-stamped items.
7143 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries
7144 (scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
7148 The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in
7149 @ref{Agenda commands}.
7151 @node Search view, Stuck projects, Timeline, Built-in agenda views
7152 @subsection Search view
7155 @cindex searching, for text
7157 This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org-mode entries.
7158 It is particularly useful to find notes.
7163 This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching a substring
7164 or specific words using a boolean logic.
7166 For example, the search string @samp{computer equipment} will find entries
7167 that contain @samp{computer equipment} as a substring. If the two words are
7168 separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match.
7169 Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using Boolean
7170 logic. The search string @samp{+computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}}
7171 will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
7172 and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
7173 not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
7174 exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g. The first @samp{+} is necessary to turn on
7175 word search, other @samp{+} characters are optional. For more details, see
7176 the docstring of the command @code{org-search-view}.
7178 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7179 Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
7180 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
7182 @node Stuck projects, , Search view, Built-in agenda views
7183 @subsection Stuck projects
7185 If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
7186 work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
7187 that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
7188 has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
7189 Org-mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
7190 projects and define next actions for them.
7195 List projects that are stuck.
7198 @vindex org-stuck-projects
7199 Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
7200 project is and how to find it.
7203 You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
7204 work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
7205 level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
7206 one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
7208 Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org-mode, identify
7209 projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
7210 indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
7211 assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
7212 and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
7213 is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
7214 contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
7215 either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
7216 with a tags/todo match@footnote{@xref{Tag searches}.}
7217 @samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and
7218 IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that are not stuck. The
7219 correct customization for this is
7222 (setq org-stuck-projects
7223 '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
7227 Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this entry
7228 will still be searched for stuck projects.
7230 @node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda Views
7231 @section Presentation and sorting
7232 @cindex presentation, of agenda items
7234 @vindex org-agenda-prefix-format
7235 Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org-mode visually prepares
7236 the items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line
7237 starts with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category}
7238 (@pxref{Categories}) of the item and other important information. You can
7239 customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
7240 The prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
7241 associated with the item.
7244 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
7245 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
7246 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
7249 @node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting
7250 @subsection Categories
7253 The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
7254 the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
7255 specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this@footnote{For
7256 backward compatibility, the following also works: if there are several
7257 such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the text below it.
7258 The first category also applies to any text before the first CATEGORY
7259 line. However, using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is
7260 incompatible with the outline structure of the document. The correct
7261 method for setting multiple categories in a buffer is using a
7269 @cindex property, CATEGORY
7270 If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
7271 (sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the
7272 special category you want to apply as the value.
7275 The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
7276 longer than 10 characters.
7278 @node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting of agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting
7279 @subsection Time-of-day specifications
7280 @cindex time-of-day specification
7282 Org-mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
7283 time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the
7284 agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
7285 ranges can be specified with two timestamps, like
7287 @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
7289 In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
7290 plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
7291 integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
7292 specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
7294 For agenda display, Org-mode extracts the time and displays it in a
7295 standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
7296 the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
7299 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7300 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7301 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7302 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7306 If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
7307 timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
7310 8:00...... ------------------
7311 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7312 10:00...... ------------------
7313 12:00...... ------------------
7314 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7315 14:00...... ------------------
7316 16:00...... ------------------
7317 18:00...... ------------------
7318 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7319 20:00...... ------------------
7320 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7323 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
7324 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
7325 The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
7326 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
7327 @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
7329 @node Sorting of agenda items, , Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting
7330 @subsection Sorting of agenda items
7331 @cindex sorting, of agenda items
7332 @cindex priorities, of agenda items
7333 Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
7334 done depends on the type of view.
7337 @vindex org-agenda-files
7338 For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
7339 default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
7340 time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
7341 of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
7342 grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
7343 Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
7344 which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
7345 for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
7346 overdue scheduled or deadline items.
7348 For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
7349 each category, sorting takes place according to priority
7350 (@pxref{Priorities}). The priority used for sorting derives from the
7351 priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to its due
7354 For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
7355 sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
7358 @vindex org-agenda-sorting-strategy
7359 Sorting can be customized using the variable
7360 @code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
7361 the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
7363 @node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda Views
7364 @section Commands in the agenda buffer
7365 @cindex commands, in agenda buffer
7367 Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary
7368 file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
7369 buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
7370 original entry location, and to edit the Org files ``remotely'' from
7371 the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
7372 removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
7374 Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
7375 the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
7378 @tsubheading{Motion}
7379 @cindex motion commands in agenda
7382 Next line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
7385 Previous line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
7386 @tsubheading{View/Go to Org file}
7391 Display the original location of the item in another window.
7392 With prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
7393 outline, not only the heading.
7397 Display original location and recenter that window.
7405 Go to the original location of the item in another window. Under Emacs
7406 22, @kbd{mouse-1} will also works for this.
7410 Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
7414 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode
7415 Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
7416 the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
7417 location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
7418 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
7419 @code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
7423 Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
7424 numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
7425 negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
7426 previously used indirect buffer.
7430 Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any links in the
7431 text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is only one link, it
7432 will be followed without a selection prompt.
7434 @tsubheading{Change display}
7435 @cindex display changing, in agenda
7438 Delete other windows.
7446 @item v d @ @r{or short} @ d
7447 @itemx v w @ @r{or short} @ w
7450 Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view,
7451 this setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda commands. Since
7452 month and year views are slow to create, they do not become the default.
7453 A numeric prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day
7454 of the year, ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example,
7455 @kbd{32 d} jumps to February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When
7456 setting day, week, or month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix
7457 argument as well. For example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in
7458 2007. If such a year specification has only one or two digits, it will
7459 be mapped to the interval 1938-2037.
7463 @vindex org-agenda-ndays
7464 Go forward in time to display the following @code{org-agenda-ndays} days.
7465 For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the following week.
7466 With prefix arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-ndays} days.
7470 Go backward in time to display earlier dates.
7478 Prompt for a date and go there.
7482 Go to the currently clocked in task in the agenda buffer.
7486 Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
7491 @item v l @ @r{or short} @ l
7492 @vindex org-log-done
7493 @vindex org-agenda-log-mode-items
7494 Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked DONE while
7495 logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
7496 entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
7497 types that should be included in log mode using the variable
7498 @code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
7499 all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
7500 prefix args @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
7501 @kbd{v L} is equivalent to @kbd{C-u v l}.
7505 @item v [ @ @r{or short} @ [
7506 Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for weekly/daily
7507 agenda and timeline views.
7513 Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked
7514 @code{ARCHIVED} are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you use the
7515 capital @kbd{A}, even all archive files are included. To exit archives mode,
7516 press @kbd{v a} again.
7520 @item v R @ @r{or short} @ R
7521 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode
7522 Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
7523 always show a table with the clocked times for the timespan and file scope
7524 covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
7525 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
7526 @code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}.
7530 @item v E @ @r{or short} @ E
7531 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode
7532 @vindex org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines
7533 Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines from the Org
7534 outline node referenced by an agenda line will be displayed below the line.
7535 The maximum number of lines is given by the variable
7536 @code{org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines}. Calling this command with a numeric
7537 prefix argument will temporarily modify that number to the prefix value.
7541 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
7542 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
7543 Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
7544 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
7548 Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes after
7549 modification of the timestamps of items with @kbd{S-@key{left}} and
7550 @kbd{S-@key{right}}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
7551 argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
7561 Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the locations of
7566 @vindex org-columns-default-format
7567 Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
7568 view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
7569 point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
7570 that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
7571 @code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
7572 @code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
7576 Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently restricted to a
7577 file or subtree (@pxref{Agenda files}).
7579 @tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
7580 @cindex filtering, by tag and effort, in agenda
7581 @cindex tag filtering, in agenda
7582 @cindex effort filtering, in agenda
7583 @cindex query editing, in agenda
7587 @vindex org-agenda-filter-preset
7588 Filter the current agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
7589 The difference between this and a custom agenda command is that filtering is
7590 very fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without
7591 having to recreate the agenda@footnote{Custom commands can preset a filter by
7592 binding the variable @code{org-agenda-filter-preset} as an option. This
7593 filter will then be applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through
7594 refreshes and more secondary filtering. The filter is a global property of
7595 the entire agenda view - in a block agenda, you should only set this in the
7596 global options section, not in the section of an individual block.}
7598 You will be prompted for a tag selection letter, SPC will mean any tag at
7599 all. Pressing @key{TAB} at that prompt will offer use completion to select a
7600 tag (including any tags that do not have a selection character). The command
7601 then hides all entries that do not contain or inherit this tag. When called
7602 with prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag. A second
7603 @kbd{/} at the prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries.
7604 If the first key you press is either @kbd{+} or @kbd{-}, the previous filter
7605 will be narrowed by requiring or forbidding the selected additional tag.
7606 Instead of pressing @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} after @kbd{/}, you can also
7607 immediately use the @kbd{\} command.
7609 @vindex org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high
7610 In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set-up allowed
7611 efforts globally, for example
7613 (setq org-global-properties
7614 '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
7616 You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of
7617 @kbd{<}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort
7618 estimate in your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value.
7619 The filter will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal,
7620 or larger-or-equal than the selected value. If the digits 0-9 are not used
7621 as fast access keys to tags, you can also simply press the index digit
7622 directly without an operator. In this case, @kbd{<} will be assumed. For
7623 application of the operator, entries without a defined effort will be treated
7624 according to the value of @code{org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high}. To filter
7625 for tasks without effort definition, press @kbd{?} as the operator.
7627 Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the variable
7628 @code{org-agenda-auto-exclude-function} is set to a user-defined function,
7629 that function can decide which tags should be excluded from the agenda
7630 automatically. Once this is set, the @kbd{/} command then accepts @kbd{RET}
7631 as a sub-option key and runs the auto exclusion logic. For example, let's
7632 say you use a @code{Net} tag to identify tasks which need network access, an
7633 @code{Errand} tag for errands in town, and a @code{Call} tag for making phone
7634 calls. You could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the
7635 Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this:
7639 (defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag)
7641 ((string= tag "Net")
7642 (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil
7643 "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org")))
7644 ((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call"))
7645 (let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time))))
7646 (or (< hour 8) (> hour 21)))))
7649 (setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function)
7655 Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When called with
7656 prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag, or that do match
7657 the effort criterion. You can achieve the same effect by pressing @kbd{+} or
7658 @kbd{-} as the first key after the @kbd{/} command.
7666 @item @r{in} search view
7667 add new search words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions
7668 (@kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will
7669 add a positive search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search
7670 term @i{must} occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a
7671 negative search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
7676 @tsubheading{Remote editing}
7677 @cindex remote editing, from agenda
7682 @cindex undoing remote-editing events
7683 @cindex remote editing, undo
7686 Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
7687 both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
7691 Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
7694 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
7695 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
7696 @item C-S-@key{right}@r{/}@key{left}
7697 Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords.
7701 @vindex org-agenda-confirm-kill
7702 Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
7703 to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
7704 is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
7705 variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
7709 Refile the entry at point.
7713 @item C-c C-x C-a @ @r{or short} @ a
7714 @vindex org-archive-default-command
7715 Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the default
7716 archiving command set in @code{org-archive-default-command}. When using the
7717 @code{a} key, confirmation will be required.
7721 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
7725 Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{archive
7730 @item C-c C-x C-s @ @r{or short} @ $
7731 Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
7732 entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
7737 @vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
7738 Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
7739 turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
7740 tags of a headline occasionally.
7744 Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
7745 agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
7749 Set the priority for the current item. Org-mode prompts for the
7750 priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC}, the priority cookie
7751 is removed from the entry.
7755 Display weighted priority of current item.
7761 Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
7762 the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
7766 @kindex S-@key{down}
7769 Decrease the priority of the current item.
7773 @item z @ @r{or also} @ C-c C-z
7774 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
7775 Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then files to the
7776 same location where state change notes are put. Depending on
7777 @code{org-log-into-drawer}, this maybe inside a drawer.
7781 Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
7785 Schedule this item, with prefix arg remove the scheduling timestamp
7789 Set a deadline for this item, with prefix arg remove the deadline.
7793 Agenda actions, to set dates for selected items to the cursor date.
7794 This command also works in the calendar! The command prompts for an
7797 m @r{Mark the entry at point for action. You can also make entries}
7798 @r{in Org files with @kbd{C-c C-x C-k}.}
7799 d @r{Set the deadline of the marked entry to the date at point.}
7800 s @r{Schedule the marked entry at the date at point.}
7801 r @r{Call @code{org-capture} with the cursor date as default date.}
7804 Press @kbd{r} afterward to refresh the agenda and see the effect of the
7807 @kindex S-@key{right}
7809 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the
7810 future. With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For
7811 example, @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. With a
7812 @kbd{C-u} prefix, change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat the
7813 command, it will continue to change hours even without the prefix arg. With
7814 a double @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix, do the same for changing minutes. The stamp
7815 is changed in the original Org file, but the change is not directly reflected
7816 in the agenda buffer. Use @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} to update the buffer.
7818 @kindex S-@key{left}
7820 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
7825 Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key @kbd{>} has
7826 been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.} on my keyboard.
7830 Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
7835 Stop the previously started clock.
7839 Cancel the currently running clock.
7843 Jump to the running clock in another window.
7845 @tsubheading{Bulk remote editing selected entries}
7846 @cindex remote editing, bulk, from agenda
7850 Mark the entry at point for bulk action.
7854 Unmark entry for bulk action.
7858 Unmark all marked entries for bulk action.
7862 Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will prompt for
7863 another key to select the action to be applied. The prefix arg to @kbd{B}
7864 will be passed through to the @kbd{s} and @kbd{d} commands, to bulk-remove
7865 these special timestamps.
7867 r @r{Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries}
7868 @r{will no longer be in the agenda, refresh (@kbd{g}) to bring them back.}
7869 $ @r{Archive all selected entries.}
7870 A @r{Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings.}
7871 t @r{Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and}
7872 @r{changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and}
7873 @r{suppressing logging notes (but not time stamps).}
7874 + @r{Add a tag to all selected entries.}
7875 - @r{Remove a tag from all selected entries.}
7876 s @r{Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates}
7877 @r{by a fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus}
7878 @r{at the prompt, for example @samp{++8d} or @samp{++2w}.}
7879 d @r{Set deadline to a specific date.}
7883 @tsubheading{Calendar commands}
7884 @cindex calendar commands, from agenda
7887 Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
7890 When in the calendar, compute and show the Org-mode agenda for the
7893 @cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
7896 @vindex org-agenda-diary-file
7897 Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor and (for
7898 block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to the Emacs diary
7899 file@footnote{This file is parsed for the agenda when
7900 @code{org-agenda-include-diary} is set.}, in a way similar to the @kbd{i}
7901 command in the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where
7902 you can add the entry.
7904 If you configure @code{org-agenda-diary-file} to point to an Org-mode file,
7905 Org will create entries (in org-mode syntax) in that file instead. Most
7906 entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it
7907 easy to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree will be
7908 built under an entry with a @code{DATE_TREE} property, or else with years as
7909 top-level entries. Emacs will prompt you for the entry text - if you specify
7910 it, the entry will be created in @code{org-agenda-diary-file} without further
7911 interaction. If you directly press @key{RET} at the prompt without typing
7912 text, the target file will be shown in another window for you to finish the
7913 entry there. See also the @kbd{k r} command.
7917 Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
7921 Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
7922 with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs calendar.
7926 Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
7931 Show holidays for three months around the cursor date.
7933 @item M-x org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files
7934 Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
7935 This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
7937 @tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
7940 @cindex exporting agenda views
7941 @cindex agenda views, exporting
7942 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
7943 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
7944 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
7945 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), PDF (extension @file{.pdf}),
7946 and plain text (any other extension). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix
7947 argument, immediately open the newly created file. Use the variable
7948 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
7949 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
7951 @tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
7954 Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
7957 @cindex agenda files, removing buffers
7959 Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
7960 for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
7961 visit Org files will not be removed.
7965 @node Custom agenda views, Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda commands, Agenda Views
7966 @section Custom agenda views
7967 @cindex custom agenda views
7968 @cindex agenda views, custom
7970 Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
7971 frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
7972 agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
7973 dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
7976 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
7977 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
7978 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
7981 @node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views
7982 @subsection Storing searches
7984 The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
7985 shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
7986 buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
7989 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
7990 Custom commands are configured in the variable
7991 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
7992 example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with
7993 Emacs Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid
7998 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
7999 '(("w" todo "WAITING")
8000 ("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
8001 ("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
8002 ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
8003 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
8004 ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
8005 ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
8006 ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
8007 ("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
8008 ("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
8013 The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
8014 after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
8015 Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
8016 similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
8017 first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
8018 prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
8019 inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
8020 parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
8021 expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
8026 as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
8029 as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
8030 results as a sparse tree
8032 as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
8035 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
8036 headlines that are also TODO items
8038 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
8039 displaying the result as a sparse tree
8041 to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
8042 containing the word @samp{FIXME}
8044 as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
8045 additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
8046 Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
8049 @node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views
8050 @subsection Block agenda
8051 @cindex block agenda
8052 @cindex agenda, with block views
8054 Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
8055 the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
8056 the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
8057 daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
8058 for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
8059 matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
8060 @code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
8064 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8065 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8069 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8077 This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
8078 you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
8079 your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
8080 @samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
8081 command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
8083 @node Setting Options, , Block agenda, Custom agenda views
8084 @subsection Setting options for custom commands
8085 @cindex options, for custom agenda views
8087 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8088 Org-mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
8089 and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
8090 commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
8091 some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
8092 options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
8093 right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
8097 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8098 '(("w" todo "WAITING"
8099 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
8100 (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
8101 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
8102 ((org-show-following-heading nil)
8103 (org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
8105 ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
8106 (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
8111 Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
8112 priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
8113 instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
8114 @kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
8115 headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
8116 will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
8117 to only a single file.
8119 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8120 For command sets creating a block agenda,
8121 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
8122 options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
8123 command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
8124 the set. The former are just added to the command entry, the latter
8125 must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
8126 agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
8127 for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
8128 the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
8129 @code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
8133 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8134 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8138 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
8139 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
8140 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8147 As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex.
8148 When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable---it
8149 fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in
8150 this interface, the @emph{values} are just Lisp expressions. So if the
8151 value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value
8155 @node Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda column view, Custom agenda views, Agenda Views
8156 @section Exporting Agenda Views
8157 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8159 If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed
8160 version of some agenda views to carry around. Org-mode can export custom
8161 agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to install Hrvoje Niksic's
8162 @file{htmlize.el}.}, Postscript, PDF@footnote{To create PDF output, the
8163 ghostscript @file{ps2pdf} utility must be installed on the system. Selecting
8164 a PDF file with also create the postscript file.}, and iCalendar files. If
8165 you want to do this only occasionally, use the command
8170 @cindex exporting agenda views
8171 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8172 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8173 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8174 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8175 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), iCalendar (extension
8176 @file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
8177 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8178 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export, for example
8180 @vindex org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines
8181 @vindex htmlize-output-type
8182 @vindex ps-number-of-columns
8183 @vindex ps-landscape-mode
8185 (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
8186 '((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8187 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8188 (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5)
8189 (htmlize-output-type 'css)))
8193 If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
8194 any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
8195 @footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
8196 or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
8197 them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
8198 that first defines custom commands for the agenda and the global
8199 TODO list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
8200 Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
8201 as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
8206 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8207 '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
8208 ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
8209 ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8214 ("~/views/home.html"))
8215 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8220 ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
8224 The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
8225 @file{.html}, Org-mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
8226 the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
8227 @file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
8228 Postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
8229 run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
8230 limit the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other
8231 extension produces a plain ASCII file.
8233 The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
8234 commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
8235 Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
8241 Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
8245 You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
8246 set options for the export commands. For example:
8249 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8251 ((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8252 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8253 (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
8254 (org-agenda-with-colors nil)
8255 (org-agenda-remove-tags t))
8260 This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it
8261 print in two columns in landscape format---the resulting page can be cut
8262 in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
8263 the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
8264 instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
8265 to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
8266 black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
8267 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
8268 in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
8271 From the command line you may also use
8273 emacs -f org-batch-store-agenda-views -kill
8276 or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting depends on the
8277 system you use, please check the FAQ for examples.}
8279 emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
8280 org-agenda-ndays 30 \
8281 org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
8282 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
8283 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
8287 which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
8288 @file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with a 30-day
8291 You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further
8292 processing by other programs. See @ref{Extracting agenda information}, for
8296 @node Agenda column view, , Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda Views
8297 @section Using column view in the agenda
8298 @cindex column view, in agenda
8299 @cindex agenda, column view
8301 Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
8302 properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
8303 quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
8304 collected by certain criteria.
8309 Turn on column view in the agenda.
8312 To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
8313 entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
8314 This causes the following issues:
8318 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8319 @vindex org-overriding-columns-format
8320 Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
8321 entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
8322 may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
8323 Org first checks if the variable @code{org-overriding-columns-format} is
8324 currently set, and if so, takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
8325 the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
8326 does not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in its file), it
8327 uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
8329 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
8330 If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
8331 turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
8332 make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
8333 also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
8334 values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
8335 cover a single day, in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
8336 vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice} (for
8337 example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two entries from the
8338 same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and its @emph{child}). In these
8339 cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
8340 some values will count double.
8342 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
8343 the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
8344 the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
8345 current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
8346 a column listing the planned total effort for a task---one of the major
8347 applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
8348 clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
8353 @node Markup, Exporting, Agenda Views, Top
8354 @chapter Markup for rich export
8356 When exporting Org-mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
8357 structure of the document as accurately as possible in the backend. Since
8358 export targets like HTML, La@TeX{}, or DocBook allow much richer formatting,
8359 Org-mode has rules on how to prepare text for rich export. This section
8360 summarizes the markup rules used in an Org-mode buffer.
8363 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
8364 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
8365 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
8366 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
8367 * Index entries:: Making an index
8368 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
8369 * Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
8372 @node Structural markup elements, Images and tables, Markup, Markup
8373 @section Structural markup elements
8376 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
8377 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
8378 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
8379 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
8381 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
8382 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
8383 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
8384 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
8385 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
8388 @node Document title, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements, Structural markup elements
8389 @subheading Document title
8390 @cindex document title, markup rules
8393 The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
8397 #+TITLE: This is the title of the document
8401 If this line does not exist, the title is derived from the first non-empty,
8402 non-comment line in the buffer. If no such line exists, or if you have
8403 turned off exporting of the text before the first headline (see below), the
8404 title will be the file name without extension.
8406 @cindex property, EXPORT_TITLE
8407 If you are exporting only a subtree by marking is as the region, the heading
8408 of the subtree will become the title of the document. If the subtree has a
8409 property @code{EXPORT_TITLE}, that will take precedence.
8411 @node Headings and sections, Table of contents, Document title, Structural markup elements
8412 @subheading Headings and sections
8413 @cindex headings and sections, markup rules
8415 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
8416 The outline structure of the document as described in @ref{Document
8417 Structure}, forms the basis for defining sections of the exported document.
8418 However, since the outline structure is also used for (for example) lists of
8419 tasks, only the first three outline levels will be used as headings. Deeper
8420 levels will become itemized lists. You can change the location of this
8421 switch globally by setting the variable @code{org-export-headline-levels}, or on a
8422 per-file basis with a line
8429 @node Table of contents, Initial text, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements
8430 @subheading Table of contents
8431 @cindex table of contents, markup rules
8433 @vindex org-export-with-toc
8434 The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first headline
8435 of the file. If you would like to get it to a different location, insert the
8436 string @code{[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]} on a line by itself at the desired
8437 location. The depth of the table of contents is by default the same as the
8438 number of headline levels, but you can choose a smaller number, or turn off
8439 the table of contents entirely, by configuring the variable
8440 @code{org-export-with-toc}, or on a per-file basis with a line like
8443 #+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
8444 #+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no TOC at all)
8447 @node Initial text, Lists, Table of contents, Structural markup elements
8448 @subheading Text before the first headline
8449 @cindex text before first headline, markup rules
8452 Org-mode normally exports the text before the first headline, and even uses
8453 the first line as the document title. The text will be fully marked up. If
8454 you need to include literal HTML, La@TeX{}, or DocBook code, use the special
8455 constructs described below in the sections for the individual exporters.
8457 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
8458 Some people like to use the space before the first headline for setup and
8459 internal links and therefore would like to control the exported text before
8460 the first headline in a different way. You can do so by setting the variable
8461 @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading} to @code{t}. On a per-file
8462 basis, you can get the same effect with @samp{#+OPTIONS: skip:t}.
8465 If you still want to have some text before the first headline, use the
8466 @code{#+TEXT} construct:
8470 #+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline.
8471 #+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]
8472 #+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the first headline
8475 @node Lists, Paragraphs, Initial text, Structural markup elements
8477 @cindex lists, markup rules
8479 Plain lists as described in @ref{Plain lists}, are translated to the backend's
8480 syntax for such lists. Most backends support unordered, ordered, and
8483 @node Paragraphs, Footnote markup, Lists, Structural markup elements
8484 @subheading Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
8485 @cindex paragraphs, markup rules
8487 Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
8488 a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
8490 To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you
8491 can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry.
8493 @cindex #+BEGIN_VERSE
8496 Great clouds overhead
8497 Tiny black birds rise and fall
8504 When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
8505 as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
8506 can include quotations in Org-mode documents like this:
8508 @cindex #+BEGIN_QUOTE
8511 Everything should be made as simple as possible,
8512 but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
8516 If you would like to center some text, do it like this:
8517 @cindex #+BEGIN_CENTER
8520 Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\
8526 @node Footnote markup, Emphasis and monospace, Paragraphs, Structural markup elements
8527 @subheading Footnote markup
8528 @cindex footnotes, markup rules
8529 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
8531 Footnotes defined in the way described in @ref{Footnotes}, will be exported by
8532 all backends. Org allows multiple references to the same note, and
8533 different backends support this to varying degrees.
8535 @node Emphasis and monospace, Horizontal rules, Footnote markup, Structural markup elements
8536 @subheading Emphasis and monospace
8538 @cindex underlined text, markup rules
8539 @cindex bold text, markup rules
8540 @cindex italic text, markup rules
8541 @cindex verbatim text, markup rules
8542 @cindex code text, markup rules
8543 @cindex strike-through text, markup rules
8544 You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=code=}
8545 and @code{~verbatim~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
8546 in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org-mode specific
8547 syntax, it is exported verbatim.
8549 @node Horizontal rules, Comment lines, Emphasis and monospace, Structural markup elements
8550 @subheading Horizontal rules
8551 @cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
8552 A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be
8553 exported as a horizontal line (@samp{<hr/>} in HTML).
8555 @node Comment lines, , Horizontal rules, Structural markup elements
8556 @subheading Comment lines
8557 @cindex comment lines
8558 @cindex exporting, not
8559 @cindex #+BEGIN_COMMENT
8561 Lines starting with @samp{#} in column zero are treated as comments and will
8562 never be exported. If you want an indented line to be treated as a comment,
8563 start it with @samp{#+ }. Also entire subtrees starting with the word
8564 @samp{COMMENT} will never be exported. Finally, regions surrounded by
8565 @samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT} ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} will not be exported.
8570 Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
8574 @node Images and tables, Literal examples, Structural markup elements, Markup
8575 @section Images and Tables
8577 @cindex tables, markup rules
8580 Both the native Org-mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
8581 the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org-mode tables,
8582 the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
8583 lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to assign
8584 a caption and a label for cross references, and in the text you can refer to
8585 the object with @code{\ref@{tab:basic-data@}}:
8588 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
8589 #+LABEL: tbl:basic-data
8594 @cindex inlined images, markup rules
8595 Some backends (HTML, La@TeX{}, and DocBook) allow you to directly include
8596 images into the exported document. Org does this, if a link to an image
8597 files does not have a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}.
8598 If you wish to define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal
8599 cross references, make sure that the link is on a line by itself and precede
8600 it with @code{#+CAPTION} and @code{#+LABEL} as follows:
8603 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
8604 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
8608 You may also define additional attributes for the figure. As this is
8609 backend-specific, see the sections about the individual backends for more
8613 @node Literal examples, Include files, Images and tables, Markup
8614 @section Literal examples
8615 @cindex literal examples, markup rules
8616 @cindex code line references, markup rules
8618 You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
8619 markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
8620 for source code and similar examples.
8621 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
8625 Some example from a text file.
8629 Note that such blocks may be @i{indented} in order to align nicely with
8630 indented text and in particular with plain list structure (@pxref{Plain
8631 lists}). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the
8632 example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional
8633 whitespace before the colon:
8637 : Some example from a text file.
8640 @cindex formatting source code, markup rules
8641 If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
8642 that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
8643 look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{Currently this works for the
8644 HTML backend, and requires the @file{htmlize.el} package version 1.34 or
8645 later. It also works for LaTeX with the listings package, if you turn on the
8646 option @code{org-export-latex-listings} and make sure that the listings
8647 package is included by the LaTeX header.}. This is done with the @samp{src}
8648 block, where you also need to specify the name of the major mode that should
8649 be used to fontify the example:
8653 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
8654 (defun org-xor (a b)
8660 Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
8661 switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
8662 numbered. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous
8663 numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal examples,
8664 Org will interpret strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as labels, and use them as
8665 targets for special hyperlinks like @code{[[(name)]]} (i.e. the reference name
8666 enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering the mouse over such a
8667 link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line, which is kind of
8670 You can also add a @code{-r} switch which @i{removes} the labels from the
8671 source code@footnote{Adding @code{-k} to @code{-n -r} will @i{keep} the
8672 labels in the source code while using line numbers for the links, which might
8673 be useful to explain those in an org-mode example code.}. With the @code{-n}
8674 switch, links to these references will be labeled by the line numbers from
8675 the code listing, otherwise links will use the labels with no parentheses.
8679 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
8680 (save-excursion (ref:sc)
8681 (goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
8683 In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
8687 @vindex org-coderef-label-format
8688 If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a
8689 @code{-l} switch to change the format, for example @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC pascal
8690 -n -r -l "((%s))"}. See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}.
8692 HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas, @xref{Text
8693 areas in HTML export}.
8698 Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
8699 switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. You need to exit by
8700 pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon exit, lines starting with @samp{*}
8701 or @samp{#} will get a comma prepended, to keep them from being interpreted
8702 by Org as outline nodes or special comments. These commas will be stripped
8703 for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and also for export.}, the edited version will
8704 then replace the old version in the Org buffer. Fixed-width regions
8705 (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space) will be edited
8706 using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select a different-mode with the
8707 variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.} to allow creating ASCII
8708 drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line will create a new
8712 Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
8713 temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label, make sure
8714 that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper
8715 formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the
8716 label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
8720 @node Include files, Index entries, Literal examples, Markup
8721 @section Include files
8722 @cindex include files, markup rules
8724 During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to
8725 include your @file{.emacs} file, you could use:
8729 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
8732 The optional second and third parameter are the markup (e.g. @samp{quote},
8733 @samp{example}, or @samp{src}), and, if the markup is @samp{src}, the
8734 language for formatting the contents. The markup is optional, if it is not
8735 given, the text will be assumed to be in Org-mode format and will be
8736 processed normally. The include line will also allow additional keyword
8737 parameters @code{:prefix1} and @code{:prefix} to specify prefixes for the
8738 first line and for each following line, as well as any options accepted by
8739 the selected markup. For example, to include a file as an item, use
8742 #+INCLUDE: "~/snippets/xx" :prefix1 " + " :prefix " "
8748 Visit the include file at point.
8751 @node Index entries, Macro replacement, Include files, Markup
8752 @section Index entries
8753 @cindex index entries, for publishing
8755 You can specify entries that will be used for generating an index during
8756 publishing. This is done by lines starting with @code{#+INDEX}. An entry
8757 the contains an exclamation mark will create a sub item. See @ref{Generating
8758 an index} for more information.
8763 #+INDEX: Application!CV
8769 @node Macro replacement, Embedded LaTeX, Index entries, Markup
8770 @section Macro replacement
8771 @cindex macro replacement, during export
8774 You can define text snippets with
8777 #+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments
8780 @noindent which can be referenced anywhere in the document (even in
8781 code examples) with @code{@{@{@{name(arg1,arg2)@}@}@}}. In addition to
8782 defined macros, @code{@{@{@{title@}@}@}}, @code{@{@{@{author@}@}@}}, etc.,
8783 will reference information set by the @code{#+TITLE:}, @code{#+AUTHOR:}, and
8784 similar lines. Also, @code{@{@{@{date(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} and
8785 @code{@{@{@{modification-time(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} refer to current date time
8786 and to the modification time of the file being exported, respectively.
8787 @var{FORMAT} should be a format string understood by
8788 @code{format-time-string}.
8790 Macro expansion takes place during export, and some people use it to
8791 construct complex HTML code.
8794 @node Embedded LaTeX, , Macro replacement, Markup
8795 @section Embedded La@TeX{}
8796 @cindex @TeX{} interpretation
8797 @cindex La@TeX{} interpretation
8799 Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. One
8800 exception, however, are scientific notes which need to be able to contain
8801 mathematical symbols and the occasional formula. La@TeX{}@footnote{La@TeX{}
8802 is a macro system based on Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the
8803 features described here as ``La@TeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for
8804 simplicity I am blurring this distinction.} is widely used to typeset
8805 scientific documents. Org-mode supports embedding La@TeX{} code into its
8806 files, because many academics are used to writing and reading La@TeX{} source
8807 code, and because it can be readily processed to produce pretty output for a
8808 number of export backends.
8811 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
8812 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
8813 * LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
8814 * Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
8815 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
8818 @node Special symbols, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX, Embedded LaTeX
8819 @subsection Special symbols
8820 @cindex math symbols
8821 @cindex special symbols
8822 @cindex @TeX{} macros
8823 @cindex La@TeX{} fragments, markup rules
8824 @cindex HTML entities
8825 @cindex La@TeX{} entities
8827 You can use La@TeX{} macros to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha} to
8828 indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow. Completion
8829 for these macros is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a few letters,
8830 and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions. Unlike La@TeX{}
8831 code, Org-mode allows these macros to be present without surrounding math
8832 delimiters, for example:
8835 Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
8838 @vindex org-entities
8839 During export, these symbols will be transformed into the native format of
8840 the exporter backend. Strings like @code{\alpha} will be exported as
8841 @code{α} in the HTML output, and as @code{$\alpha$} in the La@TeX{}
8842 output. Similarly, @code{\nbsp} will become @code{ } in HTML and
8843 @code{~} in La@TeX{}. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it
8844 like this: @samp{\Aacute@{@}stor}.
8846 A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both HTML and
8847 La@TeX{}, see the variable @code{org-entities} for the complete list.
8848 @samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, and @samp{--}, @samp{---}, and
8849 @samp{...} are all converted into special commands creating hyphens of
8850 different lengths or a compact set of dots.
8852 If you would like to see entities displayed as UTF8 characters, use the
8853 following command@footnote{You can turn this on by default by setting the
8854 variable @code{org-pretty-entities}, or on a per-file base with the
8855 @code{#+STARTUP} option @code{entitiespretty}.}:
8860 Toggle display of entities as UTF8 characters. This does not change the
8861 buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it overlays the UTF8 character
8862 for display purposes only.
8865 @node Subscripts and superscripts, LaTeX fragments, Special symbols, Embedded LaTeX
8866 @subsection Subscripts and superscripts
8870 Just like in La@TeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super-
8871 and subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in
8872 math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is
8873 not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts
8874 with curly braces. For example
8877 The mass if the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
8878 the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
8881 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
8882 To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote @samp{^} and
8883 @samp{_} with a backslash: @samp{\^} and @samp{\_}. If you write a text
8884 where the underscore is often used in a different context, Org's convention
8885 to always interpret these as subscripts can get in your way. Configure the
8886 variable @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts} to globally change this
8887 convention, or use, on a per-file basis:
8893 @noindent With this setting, @samp{a_b} will not be interpreted as a
8894 subscript, but @samp{a_@{b@}} will.
8899 In addition to showing entities as UTF8 characters, this command will also
8900 format sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way.
8903 @node LaTeX fragments, Previewing LaTeX fragments, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX
8904 @subsection La@TeX{} fragments
8905 @cindex La@TeX{} fragments
8907 @vindex org-format-latex-header
8908 Going beyond symbols and sub- and superscripts, a full formula language is
8909 needed. Org-mode can contain La@TeX{} math fragments, and it supports ways
8910 to process these for several export backends. When exporting to La@TeX{},
8911 the code is obviously left as it is. When exporting to HTML, Org invokes the
8912 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax library} (@pxref{Math formatting in
8913 HTML export}) to process and display the math@footnote{If you plan to use
8914 this regularly or on pages with significant page views, you should install
8915 @file{MathJax} on your own server in order to limit the load of our server.}.
8916 Finally, it can also process the mathematical expressions into
8917 images@footnote{For this to work you need to be on a system with a working
8918 La@TeX{} installation. You also need the @file{dvipng} program, available at
8919 @url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/}. The La@TeX{} header that will
8920 be used when processing a fragment can be configured with the variable
8921 @code{org-format-latex-header}.} that can be displayed in a browser or in
8924 La@TeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
8925 snippets will be identified as La@TeX{} source code:
8928 Environments of any kind@footnote{When @file{MathJax} is used, only the
8929 environment recognized by @file{MathJax} will be processed. When dvipng is
8930 used to create images, any La@TeX{} environments will be handled.}. The only
8931 requirement is that the @code{\begin} statement appears on a new line,
8932 preceded by only whitespace.
8934 Text within the usual La@TeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
8935 currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as
8936 math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is
8937 directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between,
8938 and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace, punctuation or a dash.
8939 For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use
8940 @samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
8943 @noindent For example:
8946 \begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments,
8947 x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures
8948 \end@{equation@} % etc
8950 If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
8951 either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
8955 @vindex org-format-latex-options
8956 If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
8957 can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
8958 ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the La@TeX{} converter.
8960 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
8961 LaTeX processing can be configured with the variable
8962 @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}. The default setting is @code{t}
8963 which means @file{MathJax} for HTML, and no processing for DocBook, ASCII and
8964 LaTeX backends. You can also set this variable on a per-file basis using one
8968 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:t @r{Do the right thing automatically (MathJax)}
8969 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng @r{Force using dvipng images}
8970 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:nil @r{Do not process La@TeX{} fragments at all}
8971 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:verbatim @r{Verbatim export, for jsMath or so}
8974 @node Previewing LaTeX fragments, CDLaTeX mode, LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
8975 @subsection Previewing LaTeX fragments
8976 @cindex LaTeX fragments, preview
8978 If you have @file{dvipng} installed, La@TeX{} fragments can be processed to
8979 produce preview images of the typeset expressions:
8984 Produce a preview image of the La@TeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
8985 over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
8986 fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
8987 with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
8988 two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
8989 process the entire buffer.
8992 Remove the overlay preview images.
8995 @vindex org-format-latex-options
8996 You can customize the variable @code{org-format-latex-options} to influence
8997 some aspects of the preview. In particular, the @code{:scale} (and for HTML
8998 export, @code{:html-scale}) property can be used to adjust the size of the
9001 @node CDLaTeX mode, , Previewing LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
9002 @subsection Using CDLa@TeX{} to enter math
9005 CDLa@TeX{} mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
9006 major La@TeX{} mode like AUC@TeX{} in order to speed-up insertion of
9007 environments and math templates. Inside Org-mode, you can make use of
9008 some of the features of CDLa@TeX{} mode. You need to install
9009 @file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
9010 AUC@TeX{}) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
9011 Don't use CDLa@TeX{} mode itself under Org-mode, but use the light
9012 version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org-mode. Turn it
9013 on for the current buffer with @code{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all
9017 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
9020 When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
9021 details see the documentation of CDLa@TeX{} mode):
9025 Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
9028 The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
9029 La@TeX{} fragment@footnote{Org-mode has a method to test if the cursor is
9030 inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
9031 @code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
9032 expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
9033 correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
9034 the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
9035 environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
9036 you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
9037 this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
9038 To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}.
9042 @vindex cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts
9043 Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a La@TeX{} fragment will insert these
9044 characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
9045 out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
9046 macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
9047 @code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
9050 Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
9051 macros, also outside La@TeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
9052 after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
9055 Pressing the single-quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
9056 the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
9057 1.5 seconds after the backquote, a help window will pop up. Character
9058 modification will work only inside La@TeX{} fragments, outside the quote
9062 @node Exporting, Publishing, Markup, Top
9066 Org-mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For
9067 printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and simple
9068 version of an Org file. HTML export allows you to publish a notes file on
9069 the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for exchange with a
9070 broad range of other applications. La@TeX{} export lets you use Org-mode and
9071 its structured editing functions to easily create La@TeX{} files. DocBook
9072 export makes it possible to convert Org files to many other formats using
9073 DocBook tools. For project management you can create gantt and resource
9074 charts by using TaskJuggler export. To incorporate entries with associated
9075 times like deadlines or appointments into a desktop calendar program like
9076 iCal, Org-mode can also produce extracts in the iCalendar format. Currently
9077 Org-mode only supports export, not import of these different formats.
9079 Org supports export of selected regions when @code{transient-mark-mode} is
9080 enabled (default in Emacs 23).
9083 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
9084 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
9085 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
9086 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
9087 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
9088 * LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to La@TeX{}, and processing to PDF
9089 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
9090 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
9091 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
9092 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
9093 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
9096 @node Selective export, Export options, Exporting, Exporting
9097 @section Selective export
9098 @cindex export, selective by tags
9100 @vindex org-export-select-tags
9101 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
9102 You may use tags to select the parts of a document that should be exported,
9103 or to exclude parts from export. This behavior is governed by two variables:
9104 @code{org-export-select-tags} and @code{org-export-exclude-tags}.
9106 Org first checks if any of the @emph{select} tags is present in the buffer.
9107 If yes, all trees that do not carry one of these tags will be excluded. If a
9108 selected tree is a subtree, the heading hierarchy above it will also be
9109 selected for export, but not the text below those headings.
9112 If none of the select tags is found, the whole buffer will be selected for
9116 Finally, all subtrees that are marked by any of the @emph{exclude} tags will
9117 be removed from the export buffer.
9119 @node Export options, The export dispatcher, Selective export, Exporting
9120 @section Export options
9121 @cindex options, for export
9123 @cindex completion, of option keywords
9124 The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide
9125 additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file.
9126 The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with @kbd{C-c
9127 C-e t}. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is
9128 correct is to type @samp{#+} and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion
9129 (@pxref{Completion}). For a summary of other in-buffer settings not
9130 specifically related to export, see @ref{In-buffer settings}.
9131 In particular, note that you can place commonly-used (export) options in
9132 a separate file which can be included using @code{#+SETUPFILE}.
9137 Insert template with export options, see example below.
9144 @cindex #+DESCRIPTION
9152 @cindex #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS
9153 @cindex #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS
9155 @cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
9156 @vindex user-full-name
9157 @vindex user-mail-address
9158 @vindex org-export-default-language
9160 #+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name)
9161 #+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from @code{user-full-name})
9162 #+DATE: a date, fixed, of a format string for @code{format-time-string}
9163 #+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from @code{user-mail-address})
9164 #+DESCRIPTION: the page description, e.g. for the XHTML meta tag
9165 #+KEYWORDS: the page keywords, e.g. for the XHTML meta tag
9166 #+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g. @samp{en} (@code{org-export-default-language})
9167 #+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning.
9168 #+TEXT: Several lines may be given.
9169 #+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @@:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ...
9170 #+BIND: lisp-var lisp-val, e.g.: org-export-latex-low-levels itemize
9171 @r{You need to confirm using these, or configure @code{org-export-allow-BIND}}
9172 #+LINK_UP: the ``up'' link of an exported page
9173 #+LINK_HOME: the ``home'' link of an exported page
9174 #+LATEX_HEADER: extra line(s) for the LaTeX header, like \usepackage@{xyz@}
9175 #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Tags that select a tree for export
9176 #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Tags that exclude a tree from export
9177 #+XSLT: the XSLT stylesheet used by DocBook exporter to generate FO file
9181 The OPTIONS line is a compact@footnote{If you want to configure many options
9182 this way, you can use several OPTIONS lines.} form to specify export settings. Here
9184 @cindex headline levels
9185 @cindex section-numbers
9186 @cindex table of contents
9187 @cindex line-break preservation
9188 @cindex quoted HTML tags
9189 @cindex fixed-width sections
9191 @cindex @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts
9193 @cindex special strings
9194 @cindex emphasized text
9195 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9196 @cindex La@TeX{} fragments
9197 @cindex author info, in export
9198 @cindex time info, in export
9200 H: @r{set the number of headline levels for export}
9201 num: @r{turn on/off section-numbers}
9202 toc: @r{turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)}
9203 \n: @r{turn on/off line-break-preservation (DOES NOT WORK)}
9204 @@: @r{turn on/off quoted HTML tags}
9205 :: @r{turn on/off fixed-width sections}
9206 |: @r{turn on/off tables}
9207 ^: @r{turn on/off @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If}
9208 @r{you write "^:@{@}", @code{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but}
9209 @r{the simple @code{a_b} will be left as it is.}
9210 -: @r{turn on/off conversion of special strings.}
9211 f: @r{turn on/off footnotes like this[1].}
9212 todo: @r{turn on/off inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text}
9213 pri: @r{turn on/off priority cookies}
9214 tags: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}}
9215 <: @r{turn on/off inclusion of any time/date stamps like DEADLINES}
9216 *: @r{turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)}
9217 TeX: @r{turn on/off simple @TeX{} macros in plain text}
9218 LaTeX: @r{configure export of La@TeX{} fragments. Default @code{auto}}
9219 skip: @r{turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading}
9220 author: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file}
9221 email: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author email into exported file}
9222 creator: @r{turn on/off inclusion of creator info into exported file}
9223 timestamp: @r{turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file}
9224 d: @r{turn on/off inclusion of drawers}
9227 These options take effect in both the HTML and La@TeX{} export, except
9228 for @code{TeX} and @code{LaTeX}, which are respectively @code{t} and
9229 @code{nil} for the La@TeX{} export.
9231 When exporting only a single subtree by selecting it with @kbd{C-c @@} before
9232 calling an export command, the subtree can overrule some of the file's export
9233 settings with properties @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, @code{EXPORT_TITLE},
9234 @code{EXPORT_TEXT}, @code{EXPORT_AUTHOR}, @code{EXPORT_DATE}, and
9235 @code{EXPORT_OPTIONS}.
9237 @node The export dispatcher, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Export options, Exporting
9238 @section The export dispatcher
9239 @cindex dispatcher, for export commands
9241 All export commands can be reached using the export dispatcher, which is a
9242 prefix key that prompts for an additional key specifying the command.
9243 Normally the entire file is exported, but if there is an active region that
9244 contains one outline tree, the first heading is used as document title and
9245 the subtrees are exported.
9250 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9251 Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a help-window
9252 listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an export or publishing
9253 command. The prefix arg is passed through to the exporter. A double prefix
9254 @kbd{C-u C-u} causes most commands to be executed in the background, in a
9255 separate Emacs process@footnote{To make this behavior the default, customize
9256 the variable @code{org-export-run-in-background}.}.
9259 Like @kbd{C-c C-e}, but only export the text that is currently visible
9260 (i.e. not hidden by outline visibility).
9261 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-e
9262 @item C-u C-u C-c C-e
9263 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9264 Call an the exporter, but reverse the setting of
9265 @code{org-export-run-in-background}, i.e. request background processing if
9266 not set, or force processing in the current Emacs process if set.
9269 @node ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, HTML export, The export dispatcher, Exporting
9270 @section ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export
9271 @cindex ASCII export
9272 @cindex Latin-1 export
9273 @cindex UTF-8 export
9275 ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org-mode
9276 file, containing only plain ASCII. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export augment the file
9277 with special characters and symbols available in these encodings.
9279 @cindex region, active
9280 @cindex active region
9281 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9285 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9286 Export as ASCII file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file
9287 will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without
9288 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9289 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9290 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9291 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will
9292 become the document title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an
9293 @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
9297 Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file.
9300 @item C-c C-e n @ @ @r{and} @ @ C-c C-e N
9301 Like the above commands, but use Latin-1 encoding.
9304 @item C-c C-e u @ @ @r{and} @ @ C-c C-e U
9305 Like the above commands, but use UTF-8 encoding.
9309 @item C-c C-e v a @ @ @r{and} @ @ C-c C-e v n @ @ @r{and} @ @ C-c C-e v u
9310 Export only the visible part of the document.
9313 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9314 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
9315 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
9316 will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur
9317 at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example,
9324 creates only top level headlines and does the rest as items. When
9325 headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following
9326 the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with
9327 the assumption that the first body line indicates the base indentation of
9328 the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to preserve
9329 the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines with less
9330 indentation than the first, these are left alone.
9332 @vindex org-export-ascii-links-to-notes
9333 Links will be exported in a footnote-like style, with the descriptive part in
9334 the text and the link in a note before the next heading. See the variable
9335 @code{org-export-ascii-links-to-notes} for details and other options.
9337 @node HTML export, LaTeX and PDF export, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Exporting
9338 @section HTML export
9341 Org-mode contains an HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
9342 HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's @emph{markdown}
9343 language, but with additional support for tables.
9346 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
9347 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org-mode
9348 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
9349 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
9350 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
9351 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
9352 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
9353 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
9354 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
9357 @node HTML Export commands, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export, HTML export
9358 @subsection HTML export commands
9360 @cindex region, active
9361 @cindex active region
9362 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9366 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9367 Export as HTML file @file{myfile.html}. For an Org file @file{myfile.org},
9368 the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file will be overwritten
9369 without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9370 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9371 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9372 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
9373 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
9374 property, that name will be used for the export.
9377 Export as HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
9380 Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file.
9383 Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With a prefix argument, do
9384 not produce the file header and footer, but just the plain HTML section for
9385 the region. This is good for cut-and-paste operations.
9394 Export only the visible part of the document.
9395 @item M-x org-export-region-as-html
9396 Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was Org-mode
9397 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
9399 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML
9400 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org-mode syntax) by HTML
9404 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9405 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become headlines,
9406 defining a general document structure. Additional levels will be exported as
9407 itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur at a different level,
9408 specify it with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
9415 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
9417 @node Quoting HTML tags, Links in HTML export, HTML Export commands, HTML export
9418 @subsection Quoting HTML tags
9420 Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{<} and
9421 @samp{>} in HTML export. If you want to include simple HTML tags
9422 which should be interpreted as such, mark them with @samp{@@} as in
9423 @samp{@@<b>bold text@@</b>}. Note that this really works only for
9424 simple tags. For more extensive HTML that should be copied verbatim to
9425 the exported file use either
9428 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
9430 #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
9434 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
9438 All lines between these markers are exported literally
9443 @node Links in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export
9444 @subsection Links in HTML export
9446 @cindex links, in HTML export
9447 @cindex internal links, in HTML export
9448 @cindex external links, in HTML export
9449 Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML. This
9450 includes automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio
9451 targets}). Links to external files will still work if the target file is on
9452 the same @i{relative} path as the published Org file. Links to other
9453 @file{.org} files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption
9454 that an HTML version also exists of the linked file, at the same relative
9455 path. @samp{id:} links can then be used to jump to specific entries across
9456 files. For information related to linking files while publishing them to a
9457 publishing directory see @ref{Publishing links}.
9459 If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a special
9460 @code{#+ATTR_HTML} line to define attributes that will be added to the
9461 @code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. Here is an example that sets @code{title}
9462 and @code{style} attributes for a link:
9466 #+ATTR_HTML: title="The Org-mode homepage" style="color:red;"
9467 [[http://orgmode.org]]
9470 @node Tables in HTML export, Images in HTML export, Links in HTML export, HTML export
9472 @cindex tables, in HTML
9473 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
9475 Org-mode tables are exported to HTML using the table tag defined in
9476 @code{org-export-html-table-tag}. The default setting makes tables without
9477 cell borders and frame. If you would like to change this for individual
9478 tables, place something like the following before the table:
9483 #+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells
9484 #+ATTR_HTML: border="2" rules="all" frame="all"
9487 @node Images in HTML export, Math formatting in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, HTML export
9488 @subsection Images in HTML export
9490 @cindex images, inline in HTML
9491 @cindex inlining images in HTML
9492 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
9493 HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and
9494 it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By
9495 default@footnote{But see the variable
9496 @code{org-export-html-inline-images}.}, images are inlined if a link does
9497 not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined,
9498 while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link
9499 @samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part
9500 itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an
9501 image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the
9502 image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that
9503 will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use:
9506 [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
9509 If you need to add attributes to an inlined image, use a @code{#+ATTR_HTML}.
9510 In the example below we specify the @code{alt} and @code{title} attributes to
9511 support text viewers and accessibility, and align it to the right.
9516 #+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider
9517 #+ATTR_HTML: alt="cat/spider image" title="Action!" align="right"
9522 and you could use @code{http} addresses just as well.
9524 @node Math formatting in HTML export, Text areas in HTML export, Images in HTML export, HTML export
9525 @subsection Math formatting in HTML export
9529 La@TeX{} math snippets (@pxref{LaTeX fragments}) can be displayed in two
9530 different ways on HTML pages. The default is to use the
9531 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax system} which should work out of the
9532 box with Org mode installation because @code{http://orgmode.org} serves
9533 @file{MathJax} for Org-mode users for small applications and for testing
9534 purposes. @b{If you plan to use this regularly or on pages with significant
9535 page views, you should install MathJax on your own server in order to limit
9536 the load of our server.} To configure @file{MathJax}, use the variable
9537 @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} or insert something like the following
9541 #+MATHJAX: align:"left" mathml:t path:"/MathJax/MathJax.js"
9544 @noindent See the docstring of the variable
9545 @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} for the meaning of the parameters in
9548 If you prefer, you can also request that La@TeX{} are processed into small
9549 images that will be inserted into the browser page. Before the availability
9550 of MathJax, this was the default method for Org files. This method requires
9551 that the @file{dvipng} program is available on your system. You can still
9552 get this processing with
9555 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
9558 @node Text areas in HTML export, CSS support, Math formatting in HTML export, HTML export
9559 @subsection Text areas in HTML export
9561 @cindex text areas, in HTML
9562 An alternative way to publish literal code examples in HTML is to use text
9563 areas, where the example can even be edited before pasting it into an
9564 application. It is triggered by a @code{-t} switch at an @code{example} or
9565 @code{src} block. Using this switch disables any options for syntax and
9566 label highlighting, and line numbering, which may be present. You may also
9567 use @code{-h} and @code{-w} switches to specify the height and width of the
9568 text area, which default to the number of lines in the example, and 80,
9569 respectively. For example
9572 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE -t -w 40
9573 (defun org-xor (a b)
9580 @node CSS support, JavaScript support, Text areas in HTML export, HTML export
9581 @subsection CSS support
9582 @cindex CSS, for HTML export
9583 @cindex HTML export, CSS
9585 @vindex org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix
9586 @vindex org-export-html-tag-class-prefix
9587 You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML exporter
9588 assigns the following special CSS classes@footnote{If the classes on TODO
9589 keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use the variables
9590 @code{org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} and
9591 @code{org-export-html-tag-class-prefix} to make them unique.} to appropriate
9592 parts of the document---your style specifications may change these, in
9593 addition to any of the standard classes like for headlines, tables, etc.
9595 p.author @r{author information, including email}
9596 p.date @r{publishing date}
9597 p.creator @r{creator info, about org-mode version}
9598 .title @r{document title}
9599 .todo @r{TODO keywords, all not-done states}
9600 .done @r{the DONE keywords, all stated the count as done}
9601 .WAITING @r{each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself}
9602 .timestamp @r{timestamp}
9603 .timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED}
9604 .timestamp-wrapper @r{span around keyword plus timestamp}
9605 .tag @r{tag in a headline}
9606 ._HOME @r{each tag uses itself as a class, "@@" replaced by "_"}
9607 .target @r{target for links}
9608 .linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
9609 .code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
9610 div.outline-N @r{div for outline level N (headline plus text))}
9611 div.outline-text-N @r{extra div for text at outline level N}
9612 .section-number-N @r{section number in headlines, different for each level}
9613 div.figure @r{how to format an inlined image}
9614 pre.src @r{formatted source code}
9615 pre.example @r{normal example}
9616 p.verse @r{verse paragraph}
9617 div.footnotes @r{footnote section headline}
9618 p.footnote @r{footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote}
9619 .footref @r{a footnote reference number (always a <sup>)}
9620 .footnum @r{footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>)}
9623 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
9624 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
9625 @vindex org-export-html-style
9626 @vindex org-export-html-extra
9627 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
9628 Each exported file contains a compact default style that defines these
9629 classes in a basic way@footnote{This style is defined in the constant
9630 @code{org-export-html-style-default}, which you should not modify. To turn
9631 inclusion of these defaults off, customize
9632 @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}}. You may overwrite these
9633 settings, or add to them by using the variables @code{org-export-html-style}
9634 (for Org-wide settings) and @code{org-export-html-style-extra} (for more
9635 granular settings, like file-local settings). To set the latter variable
9636 individually for each file, you can use
9640 #+STYLE: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="stylesheet.css" />
9644 For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You could also
9645 directly write a @code{<style>} @code{</style>} section in this way, without
9646 referring to an external file.
9648 @c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
9649 @c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
9651 @node JavaScript support, , CSS support, HTML export
9652 @subsection JavaScript supported display of web pages
9654 @cindex Rose, Sebastian
9655 Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
9656 enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
9657 program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The first one
9658 is an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
9659 navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
9660 as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
9661 view type is a @emph{folding} view much like Org provides inside Emacs. The
9662 script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and you can find
9663 the documentation for it at @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/}.
9664 We host the script at our site, but if you use it a lot, you might
9665 not want to be dependent on @url{orgmode.org} and prefer to install a local
9666 copy on your own web server.
9668 To use the script, you need to make sure that the @file{org-jsinfo.el} module
9669 gets loaded. It should be loaded by default, but you can try @kbd{M-x
9670 customize-variable @key{RET} org-modules @key{RET}} to convince yourself that
9671 this is indeed the case. All it then takes to make use of the program is
9672 adding a single line to the Org file:
9674 @cindex #+INFOJS_OPT
9676 #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
9680 If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the code
9681 needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set the following
9685 path: @r{The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from}
9686 @r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
9687 @r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
9688 view: @r{Initial view when website is first shown. Possible values are:}
9689 info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
9690 overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
9691 content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
9692 showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
9693 sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
9694 @r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
9695 @r{@code{org-export-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
9696 @r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-export-headline-levels}, each}
9697 @r{info/folding section can still contain child headlines.}
9698 toc: @r{Should the table of content @emph{initially} be visible?}
9699 @r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the "toc" with @kbd{i}.}
9700 tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
9701 @r{the variables @code{org-export-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
9702 ftoc: @r{Does the css of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"?}
9703 @r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
9704 ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
9705 @r{Make this @code{above} if the section should be above initial text.}
9706 mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
9707 @r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
9708 buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
9709 @r{default), only one such button will be present.}
9712 @vindex org-infojs-options
9713 @vindex org-export-html-use-infojs
9714 You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
9715 @code{org-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your
9716 pages, configure the variable @code{org-export-html-use-infojs}.
9718 @node LaTeX and PDF export, DocBook export, HTML export, Exporting
9719 @section La@TeX{} and PDF export
9720 @cindex La@TeX{} export
9722 @cindex Guerry, Bastien
9724 Org-mode contains a La@TeX{} exporter written by Bastien Guerry. With
9725 further processing@footnote{The default LaTeX output is designed for
9726 processing with pdftex or latex. It includes packages that are not
9727 compatible with xetex and possibly luatex. See the variables
9728 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
9729 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}.}, this backend is also used to
9730 produce PDF output. Since the La@TeX{} output uses @file{hyperref} to
9731 implement links and cross references, the PDF output file will be fully
9735 * LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invokes which commands
9736 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
9737 * Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal La@TeX{} code
9738 * Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to La@TeX{}
9739 * Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into La@TeX{} output
9740 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
9743 @node LaTeX/PDF export commands, Header and sectioning, LaTeX and PDF export, LaTeX and PDF export
9744 @subsection La@TeX{} export commands
9746 @cindex region, active
9747 @cindex active region
9748 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9752 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9753 Export as La@TeX{} file @file{myfile.tex}. For an Org file
9754 @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will
9755 be overwritten without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This
9756 requires @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9757 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9758 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
9759 title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
9760 property, that name will be used for the export.
9763 Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file.
9768 Export only the visible part of the document.
9769 @item M-x org-export-region-as-latex
9770 Convert the region to La@TeX{} under the assumption that it was Org-mode
9771 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
9773 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-latex
9774 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org-mode syntax) by La@TeX{}
9778 Export as La@TeX{} and then process to PDF.
9781 Export as La@TeX{} and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
9784 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9785 @vindex org-latex-low-levels
9786 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
9787 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
9788 will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or
9789 convert them to a custom string depending on
9790 @code{org-latex-low-levels}.
9792 If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it
9793 with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
9800 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
9802 @node Header and sectioning, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX/PDF export commands, LaTeX and PDF export
9803 @subsection Header and sectioning structure
9804 @cindex La@TeX{} class
9805 @cindex La@TeX{} sectioning structure
9806 @cindex La@TeX{} header
9807 @cindex header, for LaTeX files
9808 @cindex sectioning structure, for LaTeX export
9810 By default, the La@TeX{} output uses the class @code{article}.
9812 @vindex org-export-latex-default-class
9813 @vindex org-export-latex-classes
9814 @vindex org-export-latex-default-packages-alist
9815 @vindex org-export-latex-packages-alist
9816 @cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
9817 @cindex #+LATEX_CLASS
9818 @cindex #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
9819 @cindex property, LATEX_CLASS
9820 @cindex property, LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
9821 You can change this globally by setting a different value for
9822 @code{org-export-latex-default-class} or locally by adding an option like
9823 @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS: myclass} in your file, or with a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS:}
9824 property that applies when exporting a region containing only this (sub)tree.
9825 The class must be listed in @code{org-export-latex-classes}. This variable
9826 defines a header template for each class@footnote{Into which the values of
9827 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
9828 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist} are spliced.}, and allows you to
9829 define the sectioning structure for each class. You can also define your own
9830 classes there. @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS} or a @code{LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS}
9831 property can specify the options for the @code{\documentclass} macro. You
9832 can also use @code{#+LATEX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}} to add lines to the
9833 header. See the docstring of @code{org-export-latex-classes} for more
9836 @node Quoting LaTeX code, Tables in LaTeX export, Header and sectioning, LaTeX and PDF export
9837 @subsection Quoting La@TeX{} code
9839 Embedded La@TeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded LaTeX}, will be correctly
9840 inserted into the La@TeX{} file. This includes simple macros like
9841 @samp{\ref@{LABEL@}} to create a cross reference to a figure. Furthermore,
9842 you can add special code that should only be present in La@TeX{} export with
9843 the following constructs:
9846 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
9848 #+LaTeX: Literal LaTeX code for export
9852 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
9856 All lines between these markers are exported literally
9861 @node Tables in LaTeX export, Images in LaTeX export, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX and PDF export
9862 @subsection Tables in La@TeX{} export
9863 @cindex tables, in La@TeX{} export
9865 For La@TeX{} export of a table, you can specify a label and a caption
9866 (@pxref{Images and tables}). You can also use the @code{ATTR_LaTeX} line to
9867 request a @code{longtable} environment for the table, so that it may span
9868 several pages, or provide the @code{multicolumn} keyword that will make the
9869 table span the page in a multicolumn environment (@code{table*} environment).
9870 Finally, you can set the alignment string:
9874 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
9876 #+CAPTION: A long table
9878 #+ATTR_LaTeX: longtable align=l|lp@{3cm@}r|l
9884 @node Images in LaTeX export, Beamer class export, Tables in LaTeX export, LaTeX and PDF export
9885 @subsection Images in La@TeX{} export
9886 @cindex images, inline in La@TeX{}
9887 @cindex inlining images in La@TeX{}
9889 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
9890 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]} will be inserted into the PDF
9891 output file resulting from La@TeX{} processing. Org will use an
9892 @code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image. If you have specified a
9893 caption and/or a label as described in @ref{Images and tables}, the figure
9894 will be wrapped into a @code{figure} environment and thus become a floating
9895 element. You can use an @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line to specify the various
9896 options that can be used in the optional argument of the
9897 @code{\includegraphics} macro. To modify the placement option of the
9898 @code{figure} environment, add something like @samp{placement=[h!]} to the
9901 If you would like to let text flow around the image, add the word @samp{wrap}
9902 to the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line, which will make the figure occupy the left
9903 half of the page. To fine-tune, the @code{placement} field will be the set
9904 of additional arguments needed by the @code{wrapfigure} environment. Note
9905 that if you change the size of the image, you need to use compatible settings
9906 for @code{\includegraphics} and @code{wrapfigure}.
9910 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
9912 #+CAPTION: The black-body emission of the disk around HR 4049
9913 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
9914 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=5cm,angle=90
9915 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
9917 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=0.38\textwidth wrap placement=@{r@}@{0.4\textwidth@}
9921 If you need references to a label created in this way, write
9922 @samp{\ref@{fig:SED-HR4049@}} just like in La@TeX{}.
9924 @node Beamer class export, , Images in LaTeX export, LaTeX and PDF export
9925 @subsection Beamer class export
9927 The LaTeX class @file{beamer} allows production of high quality presentations
9928 using LaTeX and pdf processing. Org-mode has special support for turning an
9929 Org-mode file or tree into a @file{beamer} presentation.
9931 When the LaTeX class for the current buffer (as set with @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS:
9932 beamer}) or subtree (set with a @code{LaTeX_CLASS} property) is
9933 @code{beamer}, a special export mode will turn the file or tree into a beamer
9934 presentation. Any tree with not-too-deep level nesting should in principle be
9935 exportable as a beamer presentation. By default, the top-level entries (or
9936 the first level below the selected subtree heading) will be turned into
9937 frames, and the outline structure below this level will become itemize lists.
9938 You can also configure the variable @code{org-beamer-frame-level} to a
9939 different level - then the hierarchy above frames will produce the sectioning
9940 structure of the presentation.
9942 A template for useful in-buffer settings or properties can be inserted into
9943 the buffer with @kbd{M-x org-insert-beamer-options-template}. Among other
9944 things, this will install a column view format which is very handy for
9945 editing special properties used by beamer.
9947 You can influence the structure of the presentation using the following
9952 The environment that should be used to format this entry. Valid environments
9953 are defined in the constant @code{org-beamer-environments-default}, and you
9954 can define more in @code{org-beamer-environments-extra}. If this property is
9955 set, the entry will also get a @code{:B_environment:} tag to make this
9956 visible. This tag has no semantic meaning, it is only a visual aid.
9957 @item BEAMER_envargs
9958 The beamer-special arguments that should be used for the environment, like
9959 @code{[t]} or @code{[<+->]} of @code{<2-3>}. If the @code{BEAMER_col}
9960 property is also set, something like @code{C[t]} can be added here as well to
9961 set an options argument for the implied @code{columns} environment.
9962 @code{c[t]} will set an option for the implied @code{column} environment.
9964 The width of a column that should start with this entry. If this property is
9965 set, the entry will also get a @code{:BMCOL:} property to make this visible.
9966 Also this tag is only a visual aid. When this is a plain number, it will be
9967 interpreted as a fraction of @code{\textwidth}. Otherwise it will be assumed
9968 that you have specified the units, like @samp{3cm}. The first such property
9969 in a frame will start a @code{columns} environment to surround the columns.
9970 This environment is closed when an entry has a @code{BEAMER_col} property
9971 with value 0 or 1, or automatically at the end of the frame.
9973 Additional commands that should be inserted after the environment has been
9974 opened. For example, when creating a frame, this can be used to specify
9978 Frames will automatically receive a @code{fragile} option if they contain
9979 source code that uses the verbatim environment. Special @file{beamer}
9980 specific code can be inserted using @code{#+BEAMER:} and
9981 @code{#+BEGIN_beamer...#+end_beamer} constructs, similar to other export
9982 backends, but with the difference that @code{#+LaTeX:} stuff will be included
9983 in the presentation as well.
9985 Outline nodes with @code{BEAMER_env} property value @samp{note} or
9986 @samp{noteNH} will be formatted as beamer notes, i,e, they will be wrapped
9987 into @code{\note@{...@}}. The former will include the heading as part of the
9988 note text, the latter will ignore the heading of that node. To simplify note
9989 generation, it is actually enough to mark the note with a @emph{tag} (either
9990 @code{:B_note:} or @code{:B_noteNH:}) instead of creating the
9991 @code{BEAMER_env} property.
9993 You can turn on a special minor mode @code{org-beamer-mode} for editing
10003 In @code{org-beamer-mode}, this key offers fast selection of a beamer
10004 environment or the @code{BEAMER_col} property.
10007 Column view provides a great way to set the environment of a node and other
10008 important parameters. Make sure you are using a COLUMN format that is geared
10009 toward this special purpose. The command @kbd{M-x
10010 org-insert-beamer-options-template} defines such a format.
10012 Here is a simple example Org document that is intended for beamer export.
10015 #+LaTeX_CLASS: beamer
10016 #+TITLE: Example Presentation
10017 #+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik
10018 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation]
10019 #+BEAMER_FRAME_LEVEL: 2
10020 #+BEAMER_HEADER_EXTRA: \usetheme@{Madrid@}\usecolortheme@{default@}
10021 #+COLUMNS: %35ITEM %10BEAMER_env(Env) %10BEAMER_envargs(Args) %4BEAMER_col(Col) %8BEAMER_extra(Ex)
10023 * This is the first structural section
10025 ** Frame 1 \\ with a subtitle
10026 *** Thanks to Eric Fraga :BMCOL:B_block:
10029 :BEAMER_envargs: C[t]
10032 for the first viable beamer setup in Org
10033 *** Thanks to everyone else :BMCOL:B_block:
10037 :BEAMER_envargs: <2->
10039 for contributing to the discussion
10040 **** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note:
10041 ** Frame 2 \\ where we will not use columns
10042 *** Request :B_block:
10043 Please test this stuff!
10049 For more information, see the documentation on Worg.
10051 @node DocBook export, TaskJuggler export, LaTeX and PDF export, Exporting
10052 @section DocBook export
10053 @cindex DocBook export
10055 @cindex Cui, Baoqiu
10057 Org contains a DocBook exporter written by Baoqiu Cui. Once an Org file is
10058 exported to DocBook format, it can be further processed to produce other
10059 formats, including PDF, HTML, man pages, etc., using many available DocBook
10060 tools and stylesheets.
10062 Currently DocBook exporter only supports DocBook V5.0.
10065 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
10066 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
10067 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
10068 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
10069 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
10070 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
10073 @node DocBook export commands, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export, DocBook export
10074 @subsection DocBook export commands
10076 @cindex region, active
10077 @cindex active region
10078 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10082 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10083 Export as DocBook file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the DocBook XML
10084 file will be @file{myfile.xml}. The file will be overwritten without
10085 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10086 @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
10087 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10088 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10089 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10090 property, that name will be used for the export.
10093 Export as DocBook file, process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10095 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command
10096 @vindex org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command
10097 Note that, in order to produce PDF output based on exported DocBook file, you
10098 need to have XSLT processor and XSL-FO processor software installed on your
10099 system. Check variables @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} and
10100 @code{org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command}.
10102 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet
10103 The stylesheet argument @code{%s} in variable
10104 @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} is replaced by the value of
10105 variable @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet}, which needs to be set by
10106 the user. You can also overrule this global setting on a per-file basis by
10107 adding an in-buffer setting @code{#+XSLT:} to the Org file.
10109 @kindex C-c C-e v D
10111 Export only the visible part of the document.
10114 @node Quoting DocBook code, Recursive sections, DocBook export commands, DocBook export
10115 @subsection Quoting DocBook code
10117 You can quote DocBook code in Org files and copy it verbatim into exported
10118 DocBook file with the following constructs:
10121 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10123 #+DOCBOOK: Literal DocBook code for export
10127 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10131 All lines between these markers are exported by DocBook exporter
10136 For example, you can use the following lines to include a DocBook warning
10137 admonition. As to what this warning says, you should pay attention to the
10138 document context when quoting DocBook code in Org files. You may make
10139 exported DocBook XML files invalid by not quoting DocBook code correctly.
10144 <para>You should know what you are doing when quoting DocBook XML code
10145 in your Org file. Invalid DocBook XML file may be generated by
10146 DocBook exporter if you are not careful!</para>
10151 @node Recursive sections, Tables in DocBook export, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export
10152 @subsection Recursive sections
10153 @cindex DocBook recursive sections
10155 DocBook exporter exports Org files as articles using the @code{article}
10156 element in DocBook. Recursive sections, i.e. @code{section} elements, are
10157 used in exported articles. Top level headlines in Org files are exported as
10158 top level sections, and lower level headlines are exported as nested
10159 sections. The entire structure of Org files will be exported completely, no
10160 matter how many nested levels of headlines there are.
10162 Using recursive sections makes it easy to port and reuse exported DocBook
10163 code in other DocBook document types like @code{book} or @code{set}.
10165 @node Tables in DocBook export, Images in DocBook export, Recursive sections, DocBook export
10166 @subsection Tables in DocBook export
10167 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
10169 Tables in Org files are exported as HTML tables, which have been supported since
10172 If a table does not have a caption, an informal table is generated using the
10173 @code{informaltable} element; otherwise, a formal table will be generated
10174 using the @code{table} element.
10176 @node Images in DocBook export, Special characters, Tables in DocBook export, DocBook export
10177 @subsection Images in DocBook export
10178 @cindex images, inline in DocBook
10179 @cindex inlining images in DocBook
10181 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10182 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, will be exported to DocBook
10183 using @code{mediaobject} elements. Each @code{mediaobject} element contains
10184 an @code{imageobject} that wraps an @code{imagedata} element. If you have
10185 specified a caption for an image as described in @ref{Images and tables}, a
10186 @code{caption} element will be added in @code{mediaobject}. If a label is
10187 also specified, it will be exported as an @code{xml:id} attribute of the
10188 @code{mediaobject} element.
10190 @vindex org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes
10191 Image attributes supported by the @code{imagedata} element, like @code{align}
10192 or @code{width}, can be specified in two ways: you can either customize
10193 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} or use the
10194 @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line. Attributes specified in variable
10195 @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} are applied to all inline
10196 images in the Org file to be exported (unless they are overridden by image
10197 attributes specified in @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} lines).
10199 The @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line can be used to specify additional image
10200 attributes or override default image attributes for individual images. If
10201 the same attribute appears in both the @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line and
10202 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes}, the former
10203 takes precedence. Here is an example about how image attributes can be
10208 @cindex #+ATTR_DOCBOOK
10210 #+CAPTION: The logo of Org-mode
10211 #+LABEL: unicorn-svg
10212 #+ATTR_DOCBOOK: scalefit="1" width="100%" depth="100%"
10213 [[./img/org-mode-unicorn.svg]]
10216 @vindex org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions
10217 By default, DocBook exporter recognizes the following image file types:
10218 @file{jpeg}, @file{jpg}, @file{png}, @file{gif}, and @file{svg}. You can
10219 customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions} to add
10220 more types to this list as long as DocBook supports them.
10222 @node Special characters, , Images in DocBook export, DocBook export
10223 @subsection Special characters in DocBook export
10224 @cindex Special characters in DocBook export
10226 @vindex org-export-docbook-doctype
10227 @vindex org-entities
10228 Special characters that are written in @TeX{}-like syntax, such as @code{\alpha},
10229 @code{\Gamma}, and @code{\Zeta}, are supported by DocBook exporter. These
10230 characters are rewritten to XML entities, like @code{α},
10231 @code{Γ}, and @code{Ζ}, based on the list saved in variable
10232 @code{org-entities}. As long as the generated DocBook file includes the
10233 corresponding entities, these special characters are recognized.
10235 You can customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to include the
10236 entities you need. For example, you can set variable
10237 @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to the following value to recognize all
10238 special characters included in XHTML entities:
10241 "<!DOCTYPE article [
10242 <!ENTITY % xhtml1-symbol PUBLIC
10243 \"-//W3C//ENTITIES Symbol for HTML//EN//XML\"
10244 \"http://www.w3.org/2003/entities/2007/xhtml1-symbol.ent\"
10251 @node TaskJuggler export, Freemind export, DocBook export, Exporting
10252 @section TaskJuggler export
10253 @cindex TaskJuggler export
10254 @cindex Project management
10256 @uref{http://www.taskjuggler.org/, TaskJuggler} is a project management tool.
10257 It provides an optimizing scheduler that computes your project time lines and
10258 resource assignments based on the project outline and the constraints that
10261 The TaskJuggler exporter is a bit different from other exporters, such as the
10262 HTML and LaTeX exporters for example, in that it does not export all the
10263 nodes of a document or strictly follow the order of the nodes in the
10266 Instead the TaskJuggler exporter looks for a tree that defines the tasks and
10267 a optionally tree that defines the resources for this project. It then
10268 creates a TaskJuggler file based on these trees and the attributes defined in
10271 @subsection TaskJuggler export commands
10276 Export as TaskJuggler file.
10280 Export as TaskJuggler file and then open the file with TaskJugglerUI.
10285 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag
10286 Create your tasks as you usually do with Org-mode. Assign efforts to each
10287 task using properties (it's easiest to do this in the column view). You
10288 should end up with something similar to the example by Peter Jones in
10289 @url{http://www.contextualdevelopment.com/static/artifacts/articles/2008/project-planning/project-planning.org}.
10290 Now mark the top node of your tasks with a tag named
10291 @code{:taskjuggler_project:} (or whatever you customized
10292 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag} to). You are now ready to export
10293 the project plan with @kbd{C-c C-e J} which will export the project plan and
10294 open a gantt chart in TaskJugglerUI.
10296 @subsection Resources
10298 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag
10299 Next you can define resources and assign those to work on specific tasks. You
10300 can group your resources hierarchically. Tag the top node of the resources
10301 with @code{:taskjuggler_resource:} (or whatever you customized
10302 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag} to). You can optionally assign an
10303 identifier (named @samp{resource_id}) to the resources (using the standard
10304 Org properties commands, @pxref{Property syntax}) or you can let the exporter
10305 generate identifiers automatically (the exporter picks the first word of the
10306 headline as the identifier as long as it is unique, see the documentation of
10307 @code{org-taskjuggler-get-unique-id}). Using that identifier you can then
10308 allocate resources to tasks. This is again done with the @samp{allocate}
10309 property on the tasks. Do this in column view or when on the task type
10310 @kbd{C-c C-x p allocate @key{RET} <resource_id> @key{RET}}.
10312 Once the allocations are done you can again export to TaskJuggler and check
10313 in the Resource Allocation Graph which person is working on what task at what
10316 @subsection Export of properties
10318 The exporter also takes TODO state information into consideration, i.e. if a
10319 task is marked as done it will have the corresponding attribute in
10320 TaskJuggler (@samp{complete 100}). Also it will export any property on a task
10321 resource or resource node which is known to TaskJuggler, such as
10322 @samp{limits}, @samp{vacation}, @samp{shift}, @samp{booking},
10323 @samp{efficiency}, @samp{journalentry}, @samp{rate} for resources or
10324 @samp{account}, @samp{start}, @samp{note}, @samp{duration}, @samp{end},
10325 @samp{journalentry}, @samp{milestone}, @samp{reference}, @samp{responsible},
10326 @samp{scheduling}, etc for tasks.
10328 @subsection Dependencies
10330 The exporter will handle dependencies that are defined in the tasks either
10331 with the @samp{ORDERED} attribute (@pxref{TODO dependencies}), with the
10332 @samp{BLOCKER} attribute (see org-depend.el) or alternatively with a
10333 @samp{depends} attribute. Both the @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends}
10334 attribute can be either @samp{previous-sibling} or a reference to an
10335 identifier (named @samp{task_id}) which is defined for another task in the
10336 project. @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends} attribute can define multiple
10337 dependencies separated by either space or comma. You can also specify
10338 optional attributes on the dependency by simply appending it. The following
10339 examples should illustrate this:
10344 :task_id: preparation
10347 * Training material
10349 :task_id: training_material
10352 ** Markup Guidelines
10356 ** Workflow Guidelines
10363 :BLOCKER: training_material @{ gapduration 1d @} preparation
10367 @subsection Reports
10369 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports
10370 TaskJuggler can produce many kinds of reports (e.g. gantt chart, resource
10371 allocation, etc). The user defines what kind of reports should be generated
10372 for a project in the TaskJuggler file. The exporter will automatically insert
10373 some default reports in the file. These defaults are defined in
10374 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports}. They can be modified using
10375 customize along with a number of other options. For a more complete list, see
10376 @kbd{M-x customize-group @key{RET} org-export-taskjuggler @key{RET}}.
10378 For more information and examples see the Org-taskjuggler tutorial at
10379 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-taskjuggler.php}.
10381 @node Freemind export, XOXO export, TaskJuggler export, Exporting
10382 @section Freemind export
10383 @cindex Freemind export
10386 The Freemind exporter was written by Lennart Borgman.
10391 Export as Freemind mind map @file{myfile.mm}.
10394 @node XOXO export, iCalendar export, Freemind export, Exporting
10395 @section XOXO export
10396 @cindex XOXO export
10398 Org-mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output.
10399 Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and
10400 does not interpret any additional Org-mode features.
10405 Export as XOXO file @file{myfile.html}.
10408 Export only the visible part of the document.
10411 @node iCalendar export, , XOXO export, Exporting
10412 @section iCalendar export
10413 @cindex iCalendar export
10415 @vindex org-icalendar-include-todo
10416 @vindex org-icalendar-use-deadline
10417 @vindex org-icalendar-use-scheduled
10418 @vindex org-icalendar-categories
10419 @vindex org-icalendar-alarm-time
10420 Some people use Org-mode for keeping track of projects, but still prefer a
10421 standard calendar application for anniversaries and appointments. In this
10422 case it can be useful to show deadlines and other time-stamped items in Org
10423 files in the calendar application. Org-mode can export calendar information
10424 in the standard iCalendar format. If you also want to have TODO entries
10425 included in the export, configure the variable
10426 @code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. Plain timestamps are exported as VEVENT,
10427 and TODO items as VTODO. It will also create events from deadlines that are
10428 in non-TODO items. Deadlines and scheduling dates in TODO items will be used
10429 to set the start and due dates for the TODO entry@footnote{See the variables
10430 @code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}.}.
10431 As categories, it will use the tags locally defined in the heading, and the
10432 file/tree category@footnote{To add inherited tags or the TODO state,
10433 configure the variable @code{org-icalendar-categories}.}. See the variable
10434 @code{org-icalendar-alarm-time} for a way to assign alarms to entries with a
10437 @vindex org-icalendar-store-UID
10438 @cindex property, ID
10439 The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
10440 identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you set
10441 the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}, the UID will be stored in the
10442 @code{:ID:} property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
10443 entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar entries (as
10444 a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO item), Org adds
10445 prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the inclusion of the entry.
10446 In this way the UID remains unique, but a synchronization program can still
10447 figure out from which entry all the different instances originate.
10452 Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in the same
10453 directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
10456 @vindex org-agenda-files
10457 Like @kbd{C-c C-e i}, but do this for all files in
10458 @code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar
10459 file will be written.
10462 @vindex org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file
10463 Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
10464 @code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by
10465 @code{org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file}.
10468 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
10469 @vindex org-icalendar-include-body
10470 @cindex property, SUMMARY
10471 @cindex property, DESCRIPTION
10472 @cindex property, LOCATION
10473 The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION@footnote{The LOCATION
10474 property can be inherited from higher in the hierarchy if you configure
10475 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} accordingly.} properties if the selected
10476 entries have them. If not, the summary will be derived from the headline,
10477 and the description from the body (limited to
10478 @code{org-icalendar-include-body} characters).
10480 How this calendar is best read and updated, depends on the application
10481 you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
10483 @node Publishing, Working With Source Code, Exporting, Top
10484 @chapter Publishing
10487 Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure
10488 automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of interlinked org
10489 files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your exported HTML
10490 pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to a web
10493 You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML and PDF
10494 conversion so that files are available in both formats on the server.
10496 Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
10499 * Configuration:: Defining projects
10500 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
10501 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
10502 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
10505 @node Configuration, Uploading files, Publishing, Publishing
10506 @section Configuration
10508 Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
10509 and many other properties of a project.
10512 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
10513 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
10514 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
10515 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
10516 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
10517 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
10518 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
10519 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
10522 @node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration
10523 @subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
10524 @cindex org-publish-project-alist
10525 @cindex projects, for publishing
10527 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
10528 Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of one
10529 variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}. Each element of the list
10530 configures one project, and may be in one of the two following forms:
10533 ("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
10535 ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
10539 In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. A
10540 project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as the
10541 publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When a project
10542 takes the second form listed above, the individual members of the
10543 @code{:components} property are taken to be sub-projects, which group
10544 together files requiring different publishing options. When you publish such
10545 a ``meta-project'', all the components will also be published, in the
10548 @node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration
10549 @subsection Sources and destinations for files
10550 @cindex directories, for publishing
10552 Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
10553 particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files,
10554 and where to put published files.
10556 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
10557 @item @code{:base-directory}
10558 @tab Directory containing publishing source files
10559 @item @code{:publishing-directory}
10560 @tab Directory where output files will be published. You can directly
10561 publish to a webserver using a file name syntax appropriate for
10562 the Emacs @file{tramp} package. Or you can publish to a local directory and
10563 use external tools to upload your website (@pxref{Uploading files}).
10564 @item @code{:preparation-function}
10565 @tab Function or list of functions to be called before starting the
10566 publishing process, for example, to run @code{make} for updating files to be
10567 published. The project property list is scoped into this call as the
10568 variable @code{project-plist}.
10569 @item @code{:completion-function}
10570 @tab Function or list of functions called after finishing the publishing
10571 process, for example, to change permissions of the resulting files. The
10572 project property list is scoped into this call as the variable
10573 @code{project-plist}.
10577 @node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration
10578 @subsection Selecting files
10579 @cindex files, selecting for publishing
10581 By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
10582 are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
10584 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
10585 @item @code{:base-extension}
10586 @tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
10587 regular expression. Set this to the symbol @code{any} if you want to get all
10588 files in @code{:base-directory}, even without extension.
10590 @item @code{:exclude}
10591 @tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
10592 published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
10595 @item @code{:include}
10596 @tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
10597 and @code{:exclude}.
10600 @node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration
10601 @subsection Publishing action
10602 @cindex action, for publishing
10604 Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
10605 possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
10606 Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
10607 @code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
10608 export}). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using
10609 @code{org-publish-org-to-pdf}. If you want to publish the Org file itself,
10610 but with @i{archived}, @i{commented}, and @i{tag-excluded} trees removed, use
10611 @code{org-publish-org-to-org} and set the parameters @code{:plain-source}
10612 and/or @code{:htmlized-source}. This will produce @file{file.org} and
10613 @file{file.org.html} in the publishing
10614 directory@footnote{@file{file-source.org} and @file{file-source.org.html} if
10615 source and publishing directories are equal. Note that with this kind of
10616 setup, you need to add @code{:exclude "-source\\.org"} to the project
10617 definition in @code{org-publish-project-alist} to avoid that the published
10618 source files will be considered as new org files the next time the project is
10619 published.}. Other files like images only
10620 need to be copied to the publishing destination, for this you may use
10621 @code{org-publish-attachment}. For non-Org files, you always need to
10622 specify the publishing function:
10624 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
10625 @item @code{:publishing-function}
10626 @tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
10627 list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
10628 @item @code{:plain-source}
10629 @tab Non-nil means, publish plain source.
10630 @item @code{:htmlized-source}
10631 @tab Non-nil means, publish htmlized source.
10634 The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing at least
10635 a @code{:publishing-directory} property, the name of the file to be
10636 published, and the path to the publishing directory of the output file. It
10637 should take the specified file, make the necessary transformation (if any)
10638 and place the result into the destination folder.
10640 @node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration
10641 @subsection Options for the HTML/La@TeX{} exporters
10642 @cindex options, for publishing
10644 The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
10645 and La@TeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user
10646 variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along
10647 with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the
10648 respective variable for details.
10650 @vindex org-export-html-link-up
10651 @vindex org-export-html-link-home
10652 @vindex org-export-default-language
10653 @vindex org-display-custom-times
10654 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
10655 @vindex org-export-with-section-numbers
10656 @vindex org-export-section-number-format
10657 @vindex org-export-with-toc
10658 @vindex org-export-preserve-breaks
10659 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
10660 @vindex org-export-with-emphasize
10661 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
10662 @vindex org-export-with-special-strings
10663 @vindex org-export-with-footnotes
10664 @vindex org-export-with-drawers
10665 @vindex org-export-with-tags
10666 @vindex org-export-with-todo-keywords
10667 @vindex org-export-with-priority
10668 @vindex org-export-with-TeX-macros
10669 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
10670 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
10671 @vindex org-export-with-fixed-width
10672 @vindex org-export-with-timestamps
10673 @vindex org-export-author-info
10674 @vindex org-export-email
10675 @vindex org-export-creator-info
10676 @vindex org-export-with-tables
10677 @vindex org-export-highlight-first-table-line
10678 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
10679 @vindex org-export-html-style
10680 @vindex org-export-html-style-extra
10681 @vindex org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html
10682 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
10683 @vindex org-export-html-extension
10684 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
10685 @vindex org-export-html-expand
10686 @vindex org-export-html-with-timestamp
10687 @vindex org-export-publishing-directory
10688 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
10689 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
10690 @vindex org-export-html-auto-preamble
10691 @vindex org-export-html-auto-postamble
10692 @vindex user-full-name
10693 @vindex user-mail-address
10694 @vindex org-export-select-tags
10695 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
10697 @multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
10698 @item @code{:link-up} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-up}
10699 @item @code{:link-home} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-home}
10700 @item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
10701 @item @code{:customtime} @tab @code{org-display-custom-times}
10702 @item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
10703 @item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
10704 @item @code{:section-number-format} @tab @code{org-export-section-number-format}
10705 @item @code{:table-of-contents} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
10706 @item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
10707 @item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
10708 @item @code{:emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
10709 @item @code{:sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
10710 @item @code{:special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
10711 @item @code{:footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
10712 @item @code{:drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
10713 @item @code{:tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
10714 @item @code{:todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
10715 @item @code{:priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
10716 @item @code{:TeX-macros} @tab @code{org-export-with-TeX-macros}
10717 @item @code{:LaTeX-fragments} @tab @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}
10718 @item @code{:latex-listings} @tab @code{org-export-latex-listings}
10719 @item @code{:skip-before-1st-heading} @tab @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading}
10720 @item @code{:fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
10721 @item @code{:timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
10722 @item @code{:author-info} @tab @code{org-export-author-info}
10723 @item @code{:email-info} @tab @code{org-export-email-info}
10724 @item @code{:creator-info} @tab @code{org-export-creator-info}
10725 @item @code{:tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
10726 @item @code{:table-auto-headline} @tab @code{org-export-highlight-first-table-line}
10727 @item @code{:style-include-default} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}
10728 @item @code{:style} @tab @code{org-export-html-style}
10729 @item @code{:style-extra} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-extra}
10730 @item @code{:convert-org-links} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html}
10731 @item @code{:inline-images} @tab @code{org-export-html-inline-images}
10732 @item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-export-html-extension}
10733 @item @code{:xml-declaration} @tab @code{org-export-html-xml-declaration}
10734 @item @code{:html-table-tag} @tab @code{org-export-html-table-tag}
10735 @item @code{:expand-quoted-html} @tab @code{org-export-html-expand}
10736 @item @code{:timestamp} @tab @code{org-export-html-with-timestamp}
10737 @item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory}
10738 @item @code{:preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-preamble}
10739 @item @code{:postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-postamble}
10740 @item @code{:auto-preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-auto-preamble}
10741 @item @code{:auto-postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-auto-postamble}
10742 @item @code{:author} @tab @code{user-full-name}
10743 @item @code{:email} @tab @code{user-mail-address} : @code{addr;addr;..}
10744 @item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
10745 @item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
10746 @item @code{:latex-image-options} @tab @code{org-export-latex-image-default-option}
10749 Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in
10750 both HTML and La@TeX{} exporters, except for @code{:TeX-macros} and
10751 @code{:LaTeX-fragments}, respectively @code{nil} and @code{t} in the
10754 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
10755 When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist},
10756 its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if
10757 any) during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export
10758 options}), however, override everything.
10760 @node Publishing links, Sitemap, Publishing options, Configuration
10761 @subsection Links between published files
10762 @cindex links, publishing
10764 To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use
10765 something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply
10766 @samp{file:foo.org.} (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). When published, this link
10767 becomes a link to @file{foo.html}. In this way, you can interlink the
10768 pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when
10769 you publish them to HTML. If you also publish the Org source file and want
10770 to link to that, use an @code{http:} link instead of a @code{file:} link,
10771 because @code{file:} links are converted to link to the corresponding
10774 You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are careful
10775 with relative file names, and provided you have also configured Org to upload
10776 the related files, these links will work too. See @ref{Complex example}, for
10777 an example of this usage.
10779 Sometimes an Org file to be published may contain links that are
10780 only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing
10781 location. In this case, use the property
10783 @multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.6
10784 @item @code{:link-validation-function}
10785 @tab Function to validate links
10789 to define a function for checking link validity. This function must
10790 accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which
10791 the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this
10792 function returns @code{nil}, then the HTML generator will only insert a
10793 description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this
10794 function is @code{org-publish-validate-link} which checks if the given
10795 file is part of any project in @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
10797 @node Sitemap, Generating an index, Publishing links, Configuration
10798 @subsection Generating a sitemap
10799 @cindex sitemap, of published pages
10801 The following properties may be used to control publishing of
10802 a map of files for a given project.
10804 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.65
10805 @item @code{:auto-sitemap}
10806 @tab When non-nil, publish a sitemap during @code{org-publish-current-project}
10807 or @code{org-publish-all}.
10809 @item @code{:sitemap-filename}
10810 @tab Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to @file{sitemap.org} (which
10811 becomes @file{sitemap.html}).
10813 @item @code{:sitemap-title}
10814 @tab Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of file.
10816 @item @code{:sitemap-function}
10817 @tab Plug-in function to use for generation of the sitemap.
10818 Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-sitemap}, which generates a plain list
10819 of links to all files in the project.
10821 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-folders}
10822 @tab Where folders should appear in the sitemap. Set this to @code{first}
10823 (default) or @code{last} to display folders first or last,
10824 respectively. Any other value will mix files and folders.
10826 @item @code{:sitemap-alphabetically}
10827 @tab The site map is normally sorted alphabetically. Set this explicitly to
10828 @code{nil} to turn off sorting.
10830 @item @code{:sitemap-ignore-case}
10831 @tab Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default @code{nil}.
10835 @node Generating an index, , Sitemap, Configuration
10836 @subsection Generating an index
10837 @cindex index, in a publishing project
10839 Org-mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project.
10841 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
10842 @item @code{:makeindex}
10843 @tab When non-nil, generate in index in the file @file{theindex.org} and
10844 publish it as @file{theindex.html}.
10847 The file will be create when first publishing a project with the
10848 @code{:makeindex} set. The file only contains a statement @code{#+include:
10849 "theindex.inc"}. You can then built around this include statement by adding
10850 a title, style information etc.
10852 @node Uploading files, Sample configuration, Configuration, Publishing
10853 @section Uploading files
10857 For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as
10858 @command{rsync} or @command{unison}, it might be preferable not to use the built in
10859 @i{remote} publishing facilities of Org-mode which rely heavily on
10860 Tramp. Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be
10861 so efficient for multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems
10864 Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In addition
10865 to timestamp comparison, they also do content and permissions/attribute
10866 checks. For this reason you might prefer to publish your web to a local
10867 directory (possibly even @i{in place} with your Org files) and then use
10868 @file{unison} or @file{rsync} to do the synchronization with the remote host.
10870 Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to transfer to
10871 a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the project publishing
10872 definition. Simply keep all files in the correct location, process your Org
10873 files with @code{org-publish} and let the synchronization tool do the rest.
10874 You do not need, in this scenario, to include attachments such as @file{jpg},
10875 @file{css} or @file{gif} files in the project definition since the 3rd party
10878 Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote one, so
10879 that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. If you set
10880 @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag} to @code{nil}, you gain the main
10881 benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source example
10882 files you might include with @code{#+INCLUDE}. The timestamp mechanism in
10883 Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have been modified.
10885 @node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Uploading files, Publishing
10886 @section Sample configuration
10888 Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
10889 project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
10890 more complex, with a multi-component project.
10893 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
10894 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
10897 @node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration
10898 @subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
10900 This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
10901 directory on the local machine.
10904 (setq org-publish-project-alist
10906 :base-directory "~/org/"
10907 :publishing-directory "~/public_html"
10908 :section-numbers nil
10909 :table-of-contents nil
10910 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
10911 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
10912 type=\"text/css\"/>")))
10915 @node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration
10916 @subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
10918 This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
10919 Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and
10920 style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are
10923 To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
10924 your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
10925 paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
10926 publishable images in @file{~/images}, you would link to an image with
10929 file:../images/myimage.png
10932 On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
10933 same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
10934 right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
10937 (setq org-publish-project-alist
10939 :base-directory "~/org/"
10940 :base-extension "org"
10941 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
10942 :publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html
10943 :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
10945 :section-numbers nil
10946 :table-of-contents nil
10947 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
10948 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>"
10950 :auto-postamble nil)
10953 :base-directory "~/images/"
10954 :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
10955 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
10956 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
10959 :base-directory "~/other/"
10960 :base-extension "css\\|el"
10961 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
10962 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
10963 ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
10966 @node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing
10967 @section Triggering publication
10969 Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands:
10974 Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
10977 Publish the project containing the current file.
10980 Publish only the current file.
10983 Publish every project.
10986 @vindex org-publish-use-timestamps-flag
10987 Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above functions
10988 normally only publish changed files. You can override this and force
10989 publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of the commands
10990 above, or by customizing the variable @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag}.
10991 This may be necessary in particular if files include other files via
10992 @code{#+SETUPFILE:} or @code{#+INCLUDE:}.
10994 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
10995 @comment Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
10997 @node Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
10998 @chapter Working with source code
10999 @cindex Schulte, Eric
11000 @cindex Davison, Dan
11001 @cindex source code, working with
11003 Source code can be included in Org-mode documents using a @samp{src} block,
11007 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
11008 (defun org-xor (a b)
11014 Org-mode provides a number of features for working with live source code,
11015 including editing of code blocks in their native major-mode, evaluation of
11016 code blocks, tangling of code blocks, and exporting code blocks and their
11017 results in several formats. This functionality was contributed by Eric
11018 Schulte and Dan Davison, and was originally named Org-babel.
11020 The following sections describe Org-mode's code block handling facilities.
11023 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
11024 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
11025 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
11026 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
11027 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org-mode buffer
11028 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
11029 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
11030 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
11031 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
11032 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org-mode
11033 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
11034 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
11037 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11038 @comment Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
11040 @node Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
11041 @section Structure of code blocks
11042 @cindex code block, structure
11043 @cindex source code, block structure
11045 The structure of code blocks is as follows:
11049 #+begin_src <language> <switches> <header arguments>
11054 code blocks can also be embedded in text as so called inline code blocks as
11057 src_<language>@{<body>@}
11063 src_<language>[<header arguments>]@{<body>@}
11068 This name is associated with the code block. This is similar to the
11069 @samp{#+tblname} lines that can be used to name tables in Org-mode files.
11070 Referencing the name of a code block makes it possible to evaluate the
11071 block from other places in the file, other files, or from Org-mode table
11072 formulas (see @ref{The spreadsheet}).
11074 The language of the code in the block.
11076 Switches controlling exportation of the code block (see switches discussion in
11077 @ref{Literal examples})
11078 @item <header arguments>
11079 Optional header arguments control many aspects of evaluation, export and
11080 tangling of code blocks. See the @ref{Header arguments}
11081 section. Header arguments can also be set on a per-buffer or per-subtree
11082 basis using properties.
11087 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11088 @comment Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
11090 @node Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
11091 @section Editing source code
11092 @cindex code block, editing
11093 @cindex source code, editing
11096 Use @kbd{C-c '} to edit the current code block. This brings up
11097 a language major-mode edit buffer containing the body of the code
11098 block. Saving this buffer will write the new contents back to the Org
11099 buffer. Use @kbd{C-c '} again to exit.
11101 The @code{org-src-mode} minor mode will be active in the edit buffer. The
11102 following variables can be used to configure the behavior of the edit
11103 buffer. See also the customization group @code{org-edit-structure} for
11104 further configuration options.
11107 @item org-src-lang-modes
11108 If an Emacs major-mode named @code{<lang>-mode} exists, where
11109 @code{<lang>} is the language named in the header line of the code block,
11110 then the edit buffer will be placed in that major-mode. This variable
11111 can be used to map arbitrary language names to existing major modes.
11112 @item org-src-window-setup
11113 Controls the way Emacs windows are rearranged when the edit buffer is created.
11114 @item org-src-preserve-indentation
11115 This variable is especially useful for tangling languages such as
11116 python, in which whitespace indentation in the output is critical.
11117 @item org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer
11118 By default, Org will ask before returning to an open edit buffer. Set
11119 this variable to nil to switch without asking.
11122 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11123 @comment Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
11125 @node Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
11126 @section Exporting code blocks
11127 @cindex code block, exporting
11128 @cindex source code, exporting
11130 It is possible to export the @emph{contents} of code blocks, the
11131 @emph{results} of code block evaluation, @emph{neither}, or @emph{both}. For
11132 most languages, the default exports the contents of code blocks. However, for
11133 some languages (e.g. @code{ditaa}) the default exports the results of code
11134 block evaluation. For information on exporting code block bodies, see
11135 @ref{Literal examples}.
11137 The @code{:exports} header argument can be used to specify export
11140 @subsubheading Header arguments:
11142 @item :exports code
11143 The default in most languages. The body of the code block is exported, as
11144 described in @ref{Literal examples}.
11145 @item :exports results
11146 The code block will be evaluated and the results will be placed in the
11147 Org-mode buffer for export, either updating previous results of the code
11148 block located anywhere in the buffer or, if no previous results exist,
11149 placing the results immediately after the code block. The body of the code
11150 block will not be exported.
11151 @item :exports both
11152 Both the code block and its results will be exported.
11153 @item :exports none
11154 Neither the code block nor its results will be exported.
11157 It is possible to inhibit the evaluation of code blocks during export.
11158 Setting the the @code{org-export-babel-evaluate} variable to @code{nil} will
11159 ensure that no code blocks are evaluated as part of the export process. This
11160 can be useful in situations where potentially untrusted Org-mode files are
11161 exported in an automated fashion, for example when Org-mode is used as the
11162 markup language for a wiki.
11164 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11165 @comment Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
11166 @node Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
11167 @section Extracting source code
11168 @cindex source code, extracting
11169 @cindex code block, extracting source code
11171 Creating pure source code files by extracting code from source blocks is
11172 referred to as ``tangling''---a term adopted from the literate programming
11173 community. During ``tangling'' of code blocks their bodies are expanded
11174 using @code{org-babel-expand-src-block} which can expand both variable and
11175 ``noweb'' style references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}).
11177 @subsubheading Header arguments
11180 The default. The code block is not included in the tangled output.
11182 Include the code block in the tangled output. The output file name is the
11183 name of the org file with the extension @samp{.org} replaced by the extension
11184 for the block language.
11185 @item :tangle filename
11186 Include the code block in the tangled output to file @samp{filename}.
11190 @subsubheading Functions
11192 @item org-babel-tangle
11193 Tangle the current file. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v t}.
11194 @item org-babel-tangle-file
11195 Choose a file to tangle. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v f}.
11198 @subsubheading Hooks
11200 @item org-babel-post-tangle-hook
11201 This hook is run from within code files tangled by @code{org-babel-tangle}.
11202 Example applications could include post-processing, compilation or evaluation
11203 of tangled code files.
11206 @node Evaluating code blocks, Library of Babel, Extracting source code, Working With Source Code
11207 @section Evaluating code blocks
11208 @cindex code block, evaluating
11209 @cindex source code, evaluating
11211 Code blocks can be evaluated@footnote{Whenever code is evaluated there is a
11212 potential for that code to do harm. Org-mode provides a number of safeguards
11213 to ensure that it only evaluates code with explicit confirmation from the
11214 user. For information on these safeguards (and on how to disable them) see
11215 @ref{Code evaluation security}.} and the results placed in the Org-mode
11216 buffer. By default, evaluation is only turned on for @code{emacs-lisp} code
11217 blocks, however support exists for evaluating blocks in many languages. See
11218 @ref{Languages} for a list of supported languages. See @ref{Structure of
11219 code blocks} for information on the syntax used to define a code block.
11222 There are a number of ways to evaluate code blocks. The simplest is to press
11223 @kbd{C-c C-c} or @kbd{C-c C-v e} with the point on a code block@footnote{The
11224 @code{org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c} variable can be used to remove code
11225 evaluation from the @kbd{C-c C-c} key binding.}. This will call the
11226 @code{org-babel-execute-src-block} function to evaluate the block and insert
11227 its results into the Org-mode buffer.
11229 It is also possible to evaluate named code blocks from anywhere in an
11230 Org-mode buffer or an Org-mode table. @code{#+call} (or synonymously
11231 @code{#+function} or @code{#+lob}) lines can be used to remotely execute code
11232 blocks located in the current Org-mode buffer or in the ``Library of Babel''
11233 (see @ref{Library of Babel}). These lines use the following syntax.
11236 #+call: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
11237 #+function: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
11238 #+lob: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
11243 The name of the code block to be evaluated.
11245 Arguments specified in this section will be passed to the code block.
11246 @item <header arguments>
11247 Header arguments can be placed after the function invocation. See
11248 @ref{Header arguments} for more information on header arguments.
11252 @node Library of Babel, Languages, Evaluating code blocks, Working With Source Code
11253 @section Library of Babel
11254 @cindex babel, library of
11255 @cindex source code, library
11256 @cindex code block, library
11258 The ``Library of Babel'' is a library of code blocks
11259 that can be called from any Org-mode file. The library is housed in an
11260 Org-mode file located in the @samp{contrib} directory of Org-mode.
11261 Org-mode users can deposit functions they believe to be generally
11262 useful in the library.
11264 Code blocks defined in the ``Library of Babel'' can be called remotely as if
11265 they were in the current Org-mode buffer (see @ref{Evaluating code blocks}
11266 for information on the syntax of remote code block evaluation).
11269 Code blocks located in any Org-mode file can be loaded into the ``Library of
11270 Babel'' with the @code{org-babel-lob-ingest} function, bound to @kbd{C-c C-v
11273 @node Languages, Header arguments, Library of Babel, Working With Source Code
11275 @cindex babel, languages
11276 @cindex source code, languages
11277 @cindex code block, languages
11279 Code blocks in the following languages are supported.
11281 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.3 0.22 0.2
11282 @item @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier} @tab @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier}
11283 @item Asymptote @tab asymptote @tab C @tab C
11284 @item C++ @tab C++ @tab Clojure @tab clojure
11285 @item css @tab css @tab ditaa @tab ditaa
11286 @item Graphviz @tab dot @tab Emacs Lisp @tab emacs-lisp
11287 @item gnuplot @tab gnuplot @tab Haskell @tab haskell
11288 @item LaTeX @tab latex @tab Matlab @tab matlab
11289 @item Mscgen @tab mscgen @tab Objective Caml @tab ocaml
11290 @item Octave @tab octave @tab OZ @tab oz
11291 @item Perl @tab perl @tab Python @tab python
11292 @item R @tab R @tab Ruby @tab ruby
11293 @item Sass @tab sass @tab GNU Screen @tab screen
11294 @item shell @tab sh @tab SQL @tab sql
11295 @item Sqlite @tab sqlite
11298 Language-specific documentation is available for some languages. If
11299 available, it can be found at
11300 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages}.
11302 The @code{org-babel-load-languages} controls which languages are enabled for
11303 evaluation (by default only @code{emacs-lisp} is enabled). This variable can
11304 be set using the customization interface or by adding code like the following
11305 to your emacs configuration.
11308 The following disables @code{emacs-lisp} evaluation and enables evaluation of
11309 @code{R} code blocks.
11313 (org-babel-do-load-languages
11314 'org-babel-load-languages
11315 '((emacs-lisp . nil)
11319 It is also possible to enable support for a language by loading the related
11320 elisp file with @code{require}.
11323 The following adds support for evaluating @code{clojure} code blocks.
11327 (require 'ob-clojure)
11330 @node Header arguments, Results of evaluation, Languages, Working With Source Code
11331 @section Header arguments
11332 @cindex code block, header arguments
11333 @cindex source code, block header arguments
11335 Code block functionality can be configured with header arguments. This
11336 section provides an overview of the use of header arguments, and then
11337 describes each header argument in detail.
11340 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
11341 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
11344 @node Using header arguments, Specific header arguments, Header arguments, Header arguments
11345 @subsection Using header arguments
11347 The values of header arguments can be set in five different ways, each more
11348 specific (and having higher priority) than the last.
11350 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
11351 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
11352 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
11353 * Header arguments in Org-mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
11354 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
11358 @node System-wide header arguments, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments, Using header arguments
11359 @subsubheading System-wide header arguments
11360 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
11361 System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by customizing the
11362 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} variable:
11366 :results => "replace"
11373 @c org-babel-default-header-args is a variable defined in `org-babel.el'.
11375 @c ((:session . "none")
11376 @c (:results . "replace")
11377 @c (:exports . "code")
11379 @c (:noweb . "no"))
11383 @c Default arguments to use when evaluating a code block.
11386 For example, the following example could be used to set the default value of
11387 @code{:noweb} header arguments to @code{yes}. This would have the effect of
11388 expanding @code{:noweb} references by default when evaluating source code
11392 (setq org-babel-default-header-args
11393 (cons '(:noweb . "yes")
11394 (assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args)))
11397 @node Language-specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, System-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
11398 @subsubheading Language-specific header arguments
11399 Each language can define its own set of default header arguments. See the
11400 language-specific documentation available online at
11401 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel}.
11403 @node Buffer-wide header arguments, Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments
11404 @subsubheading Buffer-wide header arguments
11405 Buffer-wide header arguments may be specified through the use of a special
11406 line placed anywhere in an Org-mode file. The line consists of the
11407 @code{#+BABEL:} keyword followed by a series of header arguments which may be
11408 specified using the standard header argument syntax.
11410 For example the following would set @code{session} to @code{*R*}, and
11411 @code{results} to @code{silent} for every code block in the buffer, ensuring
11412 that all execution took place in the same session, and no results would be
11413 inserted into the buffer.
11416 #+BABEL: :session *R* :results silent
11419 @node Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Code block specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
11420 @subsubheading Header arguments in Org-mode properties
11422 Header arguments are also read from Org-mode properties (see @ref{Property
11423 syntax}), which can be set on a buffer-wide or per-heading basis. An example
11424 of setting a header argument for all code blocks in a buffer is
11427 #+property: tangle yes
11430 When properties are used to set default header arguments, they are looked up
11431 with inheritance, so the value of the @code{:cache} header argument will default
11432 to @code{yes} in all code blocks in the subtree rooted at the following
11443 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
11444 Properties defined in this way override the properties set in
11445 @code{org-babel-default-header-args}. It is convenient to use the
11446 @code{org-set-property} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-x p} to set properties
11447 in Org-mode documents.
11449 @node Code block specific header arguments, , Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Using header arguments
11450 @subsubheading Code block specific header arguments
11452 The most common way to assign values to header arguments is at the
11453 code block level. This can be done by listing a sequence of header
11454 arguments and their values as part of the @code{#+begin_src} line.
11455 Properties set in this way override both the values of
11456 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} and header arguments specified as
11457 properties. In the following example, the @code{:results} header argument
11458 is set to @code{silent}, meaning the results of execution will not be
11459 inserted in the buffer, and the @code{:exports} header argument is set to
11460 @code{code}, meaning only the body of the code block will be
11461 preserved on export to HTML or LaTeX.
11464 #+source: factorial
11465 #+begin_src haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0
11467 fac n = n * fac (n-1)
11471 Similarly, it is possible to set header arguments for inline code blocks:
11474 src_haskell[:exports both]@{fac 5@}
11477 Header arguments for ``Library of Babel'' or function call lines can be set as shown below:
11480 #+call: factorial(n=5) :exports results
11483 @node Specific header arguments, , Using header arguments, Header arguments
11484 @subsection Specific header arguments
11485 The following header arguments are defined:
11488 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
11489 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
11490 be collected and handled
11491 * file:: Specify a path for file output
11492 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
11493 directory for code block execution
11494 * exports:: Export code and/or results
11495 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
11496 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
11498 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
11499 expansion during tangling
11500 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
11501 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
11502 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
11503 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
11504 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
11505 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
11506 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
11507 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
11510 @node var, results, Specific header arguments, Specific header arguments
11511 @subsubsection @code{:var}
11512 The @code{:var} header argument is used to pass arguments to code blocks.
11513 The specifics of how arguments are included in a code block vary by language;
11514 these are addressed in the language-specific documentation. However, the
11515 syntax used to specify arguments is the same across all languages. The
11516 values passed to arguments can be literal values, values from org-mode tables
11517 and literal example blocks, or the results of other code blocks.
11519 These values can be indexed in a manner similar to arrays---see the
11520 ``indexable variable values'' heading below.
11522 The following syntax is used to pass arguments to code blocks using the
11523 @code{:var} header argument.
11529 where @code{assign} can take one of the following forms
11532 @item literal value
11533 either a string @code{"string"} or a number @code{9}.
11538 #+tblname: example-table
11544 #+source: table-length
11545 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var table=example-table
11549 #+results: table-length
11553 a code block name, as assigned by @code{#+srcname:}, followed by
11557 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var length=table-length()
11565 In addition, an argument can be passed to the code block referenced
11566 by @code{:var}. The argument is passed within the parentheses following the
11571 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var input=8
11579 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=1)
11588 @subsubheading Alternate argument syntax
11589 It is also possible to specify arguments in a potentially more natural way
11590 using the @code{#+source:} line of a code block. As in the following
11591 example arguments can be packed inside of parenthesis, separated by commas,
11592 following the source name.
11595 #+source: double(input=0, x=2)
11596 #+begin_src emacs-lisp
11601 @subsubheading Indexable variable values
11602 It is possible to reference portions of variable values by ``indexing'' into
11603 the variables. Indexes are 0 based with negative values counting back from
11604 the end. If an index is separated by @code{,}s then each subsequent section
11605 will index into the next deepest nesting or dimension of the value. The
11606 following example assigns the last cell of the first row the table
11607 @code{example-table} to the variable @code{data}:
11610 #+results: example-table
11616 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1]
11624 Ranges of variable values can be referenced using two integers separated by a
11625 @code{:}, in which case the entire inclusive range is referenced. For
11626 example the following assigns the middle three rows of @code{example-table}
11630 #+results: example-table
11637 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3]
11647 Additionally, an empty index, or the single character @code{*}, are both
11648 interpreted to mean the entire range and as such are equivalent to
11649 @code{0:-1}, as shown in the following example in which the entire first
11650 column is referenced.
11653 #+results: example-table
11659 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0]
11667 It is possible to index into the results of code blocks as well as tables.
11668 Any number of dimensions can be indexed. Dimensions are separated from one
11669 another by commas, as shown in the following example.
11673 #+begin_src emacs-lisp
11674 '(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9))
11675 ((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18))
11676 ((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27)))
11679 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1]
11687 @node results, file, var, Specific header arguments
11688 @subsubsection @code{:results}
11690 There are three classes of @code{:results} header argument. Only one option of
11691 each type may be supplied per code block.
11695 @b{collection} header arguments specify how the results should be collected
11696 from the code block
11698 @b{type} header arguments specify what type of result the code block will
11699 return---which has implications for how they will be inserted into the
11702 @b{handling} header arguments specify how the results of evaluating the code
11703 block should be handled.
11706 @subsubheading Collection
11707 The following options are mutually exclusive, and specify how the results
11708 should be collected from the code block.
11712 This is the default. The result is the value of the last statement in the
11713 code block. This header argument places the evaluation in functional
11714 mode. Note that in some languages, e.g., python, use of this result type
11715 requires that a @code{return} statement be included in the body of the source
11716 code block. E.g., @code{:results value}.
11717 @item @code{output}
11718 The result is the collection of everything printed to STDOUT during the
11719 execution of the code block. This header argument places the
11720 evaluation in scripting mode. E.g., @code{:results output}.
11723 @subsubheading Type
11725 The following options are mutually exclusive and specify what type of results
11726 the code block will return. By default, results are inserted as either a
11727 table or scalar depending on their value.
11730 @item @code{table}, @code{vector}
11731 The results should be interpreted as an Org-mode table. If a single value is
11732 returned, it will be converted into a table with one row and one column.
11733 E.g., @code{:results value table}.
11734 @item @code{scalar}, @code{verbatim}
11735 The results should be interpreted literally---they will not be
11736 converted into a table. The results will be inserted into the Org-mode
11737 buffer as quoted text. E.g., @code{:results value verbatim}.
11739 The results will be interpreted as the path to a file, and will be inserted
11740 into the Org-mode buffer as a file link. E.g., @code{:results value file}.
11741 @item @code{raw}, @code{org}
11742 The results are interpreted as raw Org-mode code and are inserted directly
11743 into the buffer. If the results look like a table they will be aligned as
11744 such by Org-mode. E.g., @code{:results value raw}.
11746 Results are assumed to be HTML and will be enclosed in a @code{begin_html}
11747 block. E.g., @code{:results value html}.
11749 Results assumed to be LaTeX and are enclosed in a @code{begin_latex} block.
11750 E.g., @code{:results value latex}.
11752 Result are assumed to be parseable code and are enclosed in a code block.
11753 E.g., @code{:results value code}.
11755 The result is converted to pretty-printed code and is enclosed in a code
11756 block. This option currently supports Emacs Lisp, python, and ruby. E.g.,
11757 @code{:results value pp}.
11760 @subsubheading Handling
11761 The following results options indicate what happens with the
11762 results once they are collected.
11765 @item @code{silent}
11766 The results will be echoed in the minibuffer but will not be inserted into
11767 the Org-mode buffer. E.g., @code{:results output silent}.
11768 @item @code{replace}
11769 The default value. Any existing results will be removed, and the new results
11770 will be inserted into the Org-mode buffer in their place. E.g.,
11771 @code{:results output replace}.
11772 @item @code{append}
11773 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
11774 be appended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
11775 inserted as with @code{replace}.
11776 @item @code{prepend}
11777 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
11778 be prepended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
11779 inserted as with @code{replace}.
11782 @node file, dir, results, Specific header arguments
11783 @subsubsection @code{:file}
11785 The header argument @code{:file} is used to specify a path for file output.
11786 An Org-mode style @code{file:} link is inserted into the buffer as the result
11787 (see @ref{Link format}). Common examples are graphical output from R,
11788 gnuplot, ditaa and LaTeX code blocks.
11790 Note that for some languages, including R, gnuplot, LaTeX and ditaa,
11791 graphical output is sent to the specified file without the file being
11792 referenced explicitly in the code block. See the documentation for the
11793 individual languages for details. In contrast, general purpose languages such
11794 as python and ruby require that the code explicitly create output
11795 corresponding to the path indicated by @code{:file}.
11798 @node dir, exports, file, Specific header arguments
11799 @subsubsection @code{:dir} and remote execution
11801 While the @code{:file} header argument can be used to specify the path to the
11802 output file, @code{:dir} specifies the default directory during code block
11803 execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with the current
11804 buffer is used. In other words, supplying @code{:dir path} temporarily has
11805 the same effect as changing the current directory with @kbd{M-x cd path}, and
11806 then not supplying @code{:dir}. Under the surface, @code{:dir} simply sets
11807 the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}.
11809 When using @code{:dir}, you should supply a relative path for file output
11810 (e.g. @code{:file myfile.jpg} or @code{:file results/myfile.jpg}) in which
11811 case that path will be interpreted relative to the default directory.
11813 In other words, if you want your plot to go into a folder called Work in your
11814 home directory, you could use
11817 #+begin_src R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work
11818 matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l")
11822 @subsubheading Remote execution
11823 A directory on a remote machine can be specified using tramp file syntax, in
11824 which case the code will be evaluated on the remote machine. An example is
11827 #+begin_src R :file plot.png :dir /dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:
11828 plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE))
11832 Text results will be returned to the local Org-mode buffer as usual, and file
11833 output will be created on the remote machine with relative paths interpreted
11834 relative to the remote directory. An Org-mode link to the remote file will be
11837 So, in the above example a plot will be created on the remote machine,
11838 and a link of the following form will be inserted in the org buffer:
11841 [[file:/scp:dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]]
11844 Most of this functionality follows immediately from the fact that @code{:dir}
11845 sets the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}, thanks to
11846 tramp. Those using XEmacs, or GNU Emacs prior to version 23 may need to
11847 install tramp separately in order for the these features to work correctly.
11849 @subsubheading Further points
11853 If @code{:dir} is used in conjunction with @code{:session}, although it will
11854 determine the starting directory for a new session as expected, no attempt is
11855 currently made to alter the directory associated with an existing session.
11857 @code{:dir} should typically not be used to create files during export with
11858 @code{:exports results} or @code{:exports both}. The reason is that, in order
11859 to retain portability of exported material between machines, during export
11860 links inserted into the buffer will *not* be expanded against @code{default
11861 directory}. Therefore, if @code{default-directory} is altered using
11862 @code{:dir}, it is probable that the file will be created in a location to
11863 which the link does not point.
11866 @node exports, tangle, dir, Specific header arguments
11867 @subsubsection @code{:exports}
11869 The @code{:exports} header argument specifies what should be included in HTML
11870 or LaTeX exports of the Org-mode file.
11874 The default. The body of code is included into the exported file. E.g.,
11875 @code{:exports code}.
11876 @item @code{results}
11877 The result of evaluating the code is included in the exported file. E.g.,
11878 @code{:exports results}.
11880 Both the code and results are included in the exported file. E.g.,
11881 @code{:exports both}.
11883 Nothing is included in the exported file. E.g., @code{:exports none}.
11886 @node tangle, comments, exports, Specific header arguments
11887 @subsubsection @code{:tangle}
11889 The @code{:tangle} header argument specifies whether or not the code
11890 block should be included in tangled extraction of source code files.
11894 The code block is exported to a source code file named after the
11895 basename (name w/o extension) of the Org-mode file. E.g., @code{:tangle
11898 The default. The code block is not exported to a source code file.
11899 E.g., @code{:tangle no}.
11901 Any other string passed to the @code{:tangle} header argument is interpreted
11902 as a file basename to which the block will be exported. E.g., @code{:tangle
11906 @node comments, no-expand, tangle, Specific header arguments
11907 @subsubsection @code{:comments}
11908 By default code blocks are tangled to source-code files without any insertion
11909 of comments beyond those which may already exist in the body of the code
11910 block. The @code{:comments} header argument can be set as follows to control
11911 the insertion of extra comments into the tangled code file.
11915 The default. No extra comments are inserted during tangling.
11917 The code block is wrapped in comments which contain pointers back to the
11918 original Org file from which the code was tangled.
11920 A synonym for ``link'' to maintain backwards compatibility.
11922 Include text from the org-mode file as a comment.
11924 The text is picked from the leading context of the tangled code and is
11925 limited by the nearest headline or source block as the case may be.
11927 Turns on both the ``link'' and ``org'' comment options.
11930 @node no-expand, session, comments, Specific header arguments
11931 @subsubsection @code{:no-expand}
11933 By default, code blocks are expanded with @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
11934 during tangling. This has the effect of assigning values to variables
11935 specified with @code{:var} (see @ref{var}), and of replacing ``noweb''
11936 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) with their targets. The
11937 @code{:no-expand} header argument can be used to turn off this behavior.
11939 @node session, noweb, no-expand, Specific header arguments
11940 @subsubsection @code{:session}
11942 The @code{:session} header argument starts a session for an interpreted
11943 language where state is preserved.
11945 By default, a session is not started.
11947 A string passed to the @code{:session} header argument will give the session
11948 a name. This makes it possible to run concurrent sessions for each
11949 interpreted language.
11951 @node noweb, cache, session, Specific header arguments
11952 @subsubsection @code{:noweb}
11954 The @code{:noweb} header argument controls expansion of ``noweb'' style (see
11955 @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) references in a code block. This header
11956 argument can have one of two values: @code{yes} or @code{no}.
11960 The default. No ``noweb'' syntax specific action is taken on evaluating
11961 code blocks, However, noweb references will still be expanded during
11964 All ``noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
11965 expanded before the block is evaluated.
11968 @subsubheading Noweb prefix lines
11969 Noweb insertions are now placed behind the line prefix of the
11970 @code{<<reference>>}.
11971 This behavior is illustrated in the following example. Because the
11972 @code{<<example>>} noweb reference appears behind the SQL comment syntax,
11973 each line of the expanded noweb reference will be commented.
11986 -- multi-line body of example
11989 Note that noweb replacement text that does not contain any newlines will not
11990 be affected by this change, so it is still possible to use inline noweb
11993 @node cache, hlines, noweb, Specific header arguments
11994 @subsubsection @code{:cache}
11996 The @code{:cache} header argument controls the use of in-buffer caching of
11997 the results of evaluating code blocks. It can be used to avoid re-evaluating
11998 unchanged code blocks. This header argument can have one of two
11999 values: @code{yes} or @code{no}.
12003 The default. No caching takes place, and the code block will be evaluated
12004 every time it is called.
12006 Every time the code block is run a sha1 hash of the code and arguments
12007 passed to the block will be generated. This hash is packed into the
12008 @code{#+results:} line and will be checked on subsequent
12009 executions of the code block. If the code block has not
12010 changed since the last time it was evaluated, it will not be re-evaluated.
12013 @node hlines, colnames, cache, Specific header arguments
12014 @subsubsection @code{:hlines}
12016 Tables are frequently represented with one or more horizontal lines, or
12017 hlines. The @code{:hlines} argument to a code block accepts the
12018 values @code{yes} or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
12022 Strips horizontal lines from the input table. In most languages this is the
12023 desired effect because an @code{hline} symbol is interpreted as an unbound
12024 variable and raises an error. Setting @code{:hlines no} or relying on the
12025 default value yields the following results.
12028 #+tblname: many-cols
12035 #+source: echo-table
12036 #+begin_src python :var tab=many-cols
12040 #+results: echo-table
12047 Leaves hlines in the table. Setting @code{:hlines yes} has this effect.
12050 #+tblname: many-cols
12057 #+source: echo-table
12058 #+begin_src python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes
12062 #+results: echo-table
12071 @node colnames, rownames, hlines, Specific header arguments
12072 @subsubsection @code{:colnames}
12074 The @code{:colnames} header argument accepts the values @code{yes},
12075 @code{no}, or @code{nil} for unassigned. The default value is @code{nil}.
12079 If an input table looks like it has column names
12080 (because its second row is an hline), then the column
12081 names will be removed from the table before
12082 processing, then reapplied to the results.
12085 #+tblname: less-cols
12091 #+srcname: echo-table-again
12092 #+begin_src python :var tab=less-cols
12093 return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab]
12096 #+results: echo-table-again
12104 No column name pre-processing takes place
12107 Column names are removed and reapplied as with @code{nil} even if the table
12108 does not ``look like'' it has column names (i.e. the second row is not an
12112 @node rownames, shebang, colnames, Specific header arguments
12113 @subsubsection @code{:rownames}
12115 The @code{:rownames} header argument can take on the values @code{yes}
12116 or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
12120 No row name pre-processing will take place.
12123 The first column of the table is removed from the table before processing,
12124 and is then reapplied to the results.
12127 #+tblname: with-rownames
12128 | one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 |
12129 | two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 |
12131 #+srcname: echo-table-once-again
12132 #+begin_src python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes
12133 return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab]
12136 #+results: echo-table-once-again
12137 | one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 |
12138 | two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 |
12142 @node shebang, eval, rownames, Specific header arguments
12143 @subsubsection @code{:shebang}
12145 Setting the @code{:shebang} header argument to a string value
12146 (e.g. @code{:shebang "#!/bin/bash"}) causes the string to be inserted as the
12147 first line of any tangled file holding the code block, and the file
12148 permissions of the tangled file are set to make it executable.
12150 @node eval, , shebang, Specific header arguments
12151 @subsubsection @code{:eval}
12152 The @code{:eval} header argument can be used to limit the evaluation of
12153 specific code blocks. @code{:eval} accepts two arguments ``never'' and
12154 ``query''. @code{:eval never} will ensure that a code block is never
12155 evaluated, this can be useful for protecting against the evaluation of
12156 dangerous code blocks. @code{:eval query} will require a query for every
12157 execution of a code block regardless of the value of the
12158 @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable.
12160 @node Results of evaluation, Noweb reference syntax, Header arguments, Working With Source Code
12161 @section Results of evaluation
12162 @cindex code block, results of evaluation
12163 @cindex source code, results of evaluation
12165 The way in which results are handled depends on whether a session is invoked,
12166 as well as on whether @code{:results value} or @code{:results output} is
12167 used. The following table shows the possibilities:
12169 @multitable @columnfractions 0.26 0.33 0.41
12170 @item @tab @b{Non-session} @tab @b{Session}
12171 @item @code{:results value} @tab value of last expression @tab value of last expression
12172 @item @code{:results output} @tab contents of STDOUT @tab concatenation of interpreter output
12175 Note: With @code{:results value}, the result in both @code{:session} and
12176 non-session is returned to Org-mode as a table (a one- or two-dimensional
12177 vector of strings or numbers) when appropriate.
12179 @subsection Non-session
12180 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
12181 This is the default. Internally, the value is obtained by wrapping the code
12182 in a function definition in the external language, and evaluating that
12183 function. Therefore, code should be written as if it were the body of such a
12184 function. In particular, note that python does not automatically return a
12185 value from a function unless a @code{return} statement is present, and so a
12186 @samp{return} statement will usually be required in python.
12188 This is the only one of the four evaluation contexts in which the code is
12189 automatically wrapped in a function definition.
12191 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
12192 The code is passed to the interpreter as an external process, and the
12193 contents of the standard output stream are returned as text. (In certain
12194 languages this also contains the error output stream; this is an area for
12197 @subsection @code{:session}
12198 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
12199 The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
12200 inferior process. The result returned is the result of the last evaluation
12201 performed by the interpreter. (This is obtained in a language-specific
12202 manner: the value of the variable @code{_} in python and ruby, and the value
12203 of @code{.Last.value} in R).
12205 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
12206 The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
12207 inferior process. The result returned is the concatenation of the sequence of
12208 (text) output from the interactive interpreter. Notice that this is not
12209 necessarily the same as what would be sent to @code{STDOUT} if the same code
12210 were passed to a non-interactive interpreter running as an external
12211 process. For example, compare the following two blocks:
12214 #+begin_src python :results output
12225 In non-session mode, the '2' is not printed and does not appear.
12227 #+begin_src python :results output :session
12239 But in @code{:session} mode, the interactive interpreter receives input '2'
12240 and prints out its value, '2'. (Indeed, the other print statements are
12243 @node Noweb reference syntax, Key bindings and useful functions, Results of evaluation, Working With Source Code
12244 @section Noweb reference syntax
12245 @cindex code block, noweb reference
12246 @cindex syntax, noweb
12247 @cindex source code, noweb reference
12249 The ``noweb'' (see @uref{http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/}) Literate
12250 Programming system allows named blocks of code to be referenced by using the
12251 familiar Noweb syntax:
12254 <<code-block-name>>
12257 When a code block is tangled or evaluated, whether or not ``noweb''
12258 references are expanded depends upon the value of the @code{:noweb} header
12259 argument. If @code{:noweb yes}, then a Noweb reference is expanded before
12260 evaluation. If @code{:noweb no}, the default, then the reference is not
12261 expanded before evaluation.
12263 Note: the default value, @code{:noweb no}, was chosen to ensure that
12264 correct code is not broken in a language, such as Ruby, where
12265 @code{<<arg>>} is a syntactically valid construct. If @code{<<arg>>} is not
12266 syntactically valid in languages that you use, then please consider setting
12269 @node Key bindings and useful functions, Batch execution, Noweb reference syntax, Working With Source Code
12270 @section Key bindings and useful functions
12271 @cindex code block, key bindings
12273 Many common Org-mode key sequences are re-bound depending on
12276 Within a code block, the following key bindings
12279 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12281 @item @kbd{C-c C-c} @tab org-babel-execute-src-block
12283 @item @kbd{C-c C-o} @tab org-babel-open-src-block-result
12285 @item @kbd{C-@key{up}} @tab org-babel-load-in-session
12287 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab org-babel-pop-to-session
12290 In an Org-mode buffer, the following key bindings are active:
12292 @multitable @columnfractions 0.45 0.55
12294 @kindex C-c C-v C-a
12295 @item @kbd{C-c C-v a} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab org-babel-sha1-hash
12297 @kindex C-c C-v C-b
12298 @item @kbd{C-c C-v b} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab org-babel-execute-buffer
12300 @kindex C-c C-v C-f
12301 @item @kbd{C-c C-v f} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab org-babel-tangle-file
12303 @item @kbd{C-c C-v g} @tab org-babel-goto-named-source-block
12305 @item @kbd{C-c C-v h} @tab org-babel-describe-bindings
12307 @kindex C-c C-v C-l
12308 @item @kbd{C-c C-v l} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab org-babel-lob-ingest
12310 @kindex C-c C-v C-p
12311 @item @kbd{C-c C-v p} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab org-babel-expand-src-block
12313 @kindex C-c C-v C-s
12314 @item @kbd{C-c C-v s} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab org-babel-execute-subtree
12316 @kindex C-c C-v C-t
12317 @item @kbd{C-c C-v t} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab org-babel-tangle
12319 @kindex C-c C-v C-z
12320 @item @kbd{C-c C-v z} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab org-babel-switch-to-session
12323 @c When possible these keybindings were extended to work when the control key is
12324 @c kept pressed, resulting in the following additional keybindings.
12326 @c @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12327 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab org-babel-sha1-hash
12328 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab org-babel-execute-buffer
12329 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab org-babel-tangle-file
12330 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab org-babel-lob-ingest
12331 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab org-babel-expand-src-block
12332 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab org-babel-execute-subtree
12333 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab org-babel-tangle
12334 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab org-babel-switch-to-session
12337 @node Batch execution, , Key bindings and useful functions, Working With Source Code
12338 @section Batch execution
12339 @cindex code block, batch execution
12340 @cindex source code, batch execution
12342 It is possible to call functions from the command line. This shell
12343 script calls @code{org-babel-tangle} on every one of its arguments.
12345 Be sure to adjust the paths to fit your system.
12349 # -*- mode: shell-script -*-
12351 # tangle a file with org-mode
12356 # wrap each argument in the code required to call tangle on it
12358 FILES="$FILES \"$i\""
12363 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/lisp/\"))
12364 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/contrib/lisp/\"))
12365 (require 'org)(require 'org-exp)(require 'ob)(require 'ob-tangle)
12366 (mapc (lambda (file)
12367 (find-file (expand-file-name file \"$DIR\"))
12369 (kill-buffer)) '($FILES)))"
12372 @node Miscellaneous, Hacking, Working With Source Code, Top
12373 @chapter Miscellaneous
12376 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
12377 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
12378 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
12379 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
12380 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
12381 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
12382 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
12383 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
12384 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
12385 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
12389 @node Completion, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous
12390 @section Completion
12391 @cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
12392 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
12393 @cindex completion, of dictionary words
12394 @cindex completion, of option keywords
12395 @cindex completion, of tags
12396 @cindex completion, of property keys
12397 @cindex completion, of link abbreviations
12398 @cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
12399 @cindex TODO keywords completion
12400 @cindex dictionary word completion
12401 @cindex option keyword completion
12402 @cindex tag completion
12403 @cindex link abbreviations, completion of
12405 Emacs would not be Emacs without completion, and Org-mode uses it whenever it
12406 makes sense. If you prefer an @i{iswitchb}- or @i{ido}-like interface for
12407 some of the completion prompts, you can specify your preference by setting at
12408 most one of the variables @code{org-completion-use-iswitchb}
12409 @code{org-completion-use-ido}.
12411 Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does
12412 not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into
12413 the buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
12416 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
12418 Complete word at point
12421 At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
12423 After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
12425 After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
12426 can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
12428 After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
12429 from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
12430 @samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
12431 dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
12433 After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
12434 of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
12437 After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
12439 After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
12440 @samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org-mode. When the
12441 option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again
12442 will insert example settings for this keyword.
12444 In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords,
12445 i.e. valid keys for this line.
12447 Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
12451 @node Easy Templates, Speed keys, Completion, Miscellaneous
12452 @section Easy Templates
12453 @cindex template insertion
12454 @cindex insertion, of templates
12456 Org-mode supports insertion of empty structural elements (like
12457 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} and @code{#+END_SRC} pairs) with just a few key
12458 strokes. This is achieved through a native template expansion mechanism.
12459 Note that Emacs has several other template mechanisms which could be used in
12460 a similar way, for example @file{yasnippet}.
12462 To insert a structural element, type a @samp{<}, followed by a template
12463 selector and @kbd{@key{TAB}}. Completion takes effect only when the above
12464 keystrokes are typed on a line by itself.
12466 The following template selectors are currently supported.
12468 @multitable @columnfractions 0.1 0.9
12469 @item @kbd{s} @tab @code{#+begin_src ... #+end_src}
12470 @item @kbd{e} @tab @code{#+begin_example ... #+end_example}
12471 @item @kbd{q} @tab @code{#+begin_quote ... #+end_quote}
12472 @item @kbd{v} @tab @code{#+begin_verse ... #+end_verse}
12473 @item @kbd{c} @tab @code{#+begin_center ... #+end_center}
12474 @item @kbd{l} @tab @code{#+begin_latex ... #+end_latex}
12475 @item @kbd{L} @tab @code{#+latex:}
12476 @item @kbd{h} @tab @code{#+begin_html ... #+end_html}
12477 @item @kbd{H} @tab @code{#+html:}
12478 @item @kbd{a} @tab @code{#+begin_ascii ... #+end_ascii}
12479 @item @kbd{A} @tab @code{#+ascii:}
12480 @item @kbd{i} @tab @code{#+include:} line
12483 For example, on an empty line, typing "<e" and then pressing TAB, will expand
12484 into a complete EXAMPLE template.
12486 You can install additional templates by customizing the variable
12487 @code{org-structure-template-alist}. Refer docstring of the variable for
12488 additional details.
12490 @node Speed keys, Code evaluation security, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous
12491 @section Speed keys
12493 @vindex org-use-speed-commands
12494 @vindex org-speed-commands-user
12496 Single keys can be made to execute commands when the cursor is at the
12497 beginning of a headline, i.e. before the first star. Configure the variable
12498 @code{org-use-speed-commands} to activate this feature. There is a
12499 pre-defined list of commands, and you can add more such commands using the
12500 variable @code{org-speed-commands-user}. Speed keys do not only speed up
12501 navigation and other commands, but they also provide an alternative way to
12502 execute commands bound to keys that are not or not easily available on a tty,
12503 or on a small mobile device with a limited keyboard.
12505 To see which commands are available, activate the feature and press @kbd{?}
12506 with the cursor at the beginning of a headline.
12508 @node Code evaluation security, Customization, Speed keys, Miscellaneous
12509 @section Code evaluation and security issues
12511 Org provides tools to work with the code snippets, including evaluating them.
12513 Running code on your machine always comes with a security risk. Badly
12514 written or malicious code can be executed on purpose or by accident. Org has
12515 default settings which will only evaluate such code if you give explicit
12516 permission to do so, and as a casual user of these features you should leave
12517 these precautions intact.
12519 For people who regularly work with such code, the confirmation prompts can
12520 become annoying, and you might want to turn them off. This can be done, but
12521 you must be aware of the risks that are involved.
12523 Code evaluation can happen under the following circumstances:
12526 @item Source code blocks
12527 Source code blocks can be evaluated during export, or when pressing @kbd{C-c
12528 C-c} in the block. The most important thing to realize here is that Org mode
12529 files which contain code snippets are, in a certain sense, like executable
12530 files. So you should accept them and load them into Emacs only from trusted
12531 sources - just like you would do with a program you install on your computer.
12533 Make sure you know what you are doing before customizing the variables
12534 which take off the default security brakes.
12536 @defopt org-confirm-babel-evaluate
12537 When set to t user is queried before code block evaluation
12540 @item Following @code{shell} and @code{elisp} links
12541 Org has two link types that can directly evaluate code (@pxref{External
12542 links}). These links can be problematic because the code to be evaluated is
12545 @defopt org-confirm-shell-link-function
12546 Function to queries user about shell link execution.
12548 @defopt org-confirm-elisp-link-function
12549 Functions to query user for Emacs Lisp link execution.
12552 @item Formulas in tables
12553 Formulas in tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}) are code that is evaluated
12554 either by the @i{calc} interpreter, or by the @i{Emacs Lisp} interpreter.
12557 @node Customization, In-buffer settings, Code evaluation security, Miscellaneous
12558 @section Customization
12559 @cindex customization
12560 @cindex options, for customization
12561 @cindex variables, for customization
12563 There are more than 180 variables that can be used to customize
12564 Org. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not
12565 describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization
12566 variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize}. Or select
12567 @code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many
12568 settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special
12569 lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
12571 @node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous
12572 @section Summary of in-buffer settings
12573 @cindex in-buffer settings
12574 @cindex special keywords
12576 Org-mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
12577 per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a
12578 keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several
12579 setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple
12580 lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout
12581 the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the
12582 buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to
12583 activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only
12584 when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
12586 @vindex org-archive-location
12588 @item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
12589 This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for
12590 all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end
12591 of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
12592 The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
12594 This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies
12595 for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the
12596 end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
12597 @item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....
12598 @cindex property, COLUMNS
12599 Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
12600 columns view is invoked in locations where no @code{COLUMNS} property
12602 @item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
12603 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
12604 @vindex org-table-formula
12605 Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This
12606 line set the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}.
12607 The global version of this variable is
12608 @code{org-table-formula-constants}.
12609 @item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
12610 Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including the
12612 @item #+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....
12613 @vindex org-drawers
12614 Set the file-local set of drawers. The corresponding global variable is
12615 @code{org-drawers}.
12616 @item #+LINK: linkword replace
12617 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
12618 These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
12619 @xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is
12620 @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
12621 @item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
12622 @vindex org-highest-priority
12623 @vindex org-lowest-priority
12624 @vindex org-default-priority
12625 This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
12626 must be either letters A-Z or numbers 0-9. The highest priority must
12627 have a lower ASCII number that the lowest priority.
12628 @item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
12629 This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
12630 buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
12631 @cindex #+SETUPFILE
12632 @item #+SETUPFILE: file
12633 This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup. Normally this is
12634 entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed for option-setting lines
12635 (i.e. when starting Org-mode for a file, when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in a
12636 settings line, or when exporting), then the contents of this file are parsed
12637 as if they had been included in the buffer. In particular, the file can be
12638 any other Org-mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
12639 cursor is in the line with @kbd{C-c '}.
12642 This line sets options to be used at startup of Org-mode, when an
12643 Org file is being visited.
12645 The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the outline
12646 tree. The corresponding variable for global default settings is
12647 @code{org-startup-folded}, with a default value @code{t}, which means
12649 @vindex org-startup-folded
12650 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
12651 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
12652 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
12653 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
12655 overview @r{top-level headlines only}
12656 content @r{all headlines}
12657 showall @r{no folding of any entries}
12658 showeverything @r{show even drawer contents}
12661 @vindex org-startup-indented
12662 @cindex @code{indent}, STARTUP keyword
12663 @cindex @code{noindent}, STARTUP keyword
12664 Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable
12665 @code{org-startup-indented}@footnote{Emacs 23 and Org-mode 6.29 are required}
12667 indent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned on}
12668 noindent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned off}
12671 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
12672 Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This
12673 is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding
12674 variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value
12676 @cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
12677 @cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
12679 align @r{align all tables}
12680 noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
12682 @vindex org-log-done
12683 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
12684 @vindex org-log-repeat
12685 Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock intervals can be
12686 configured using these options (see variables @code{org-log-done},
12687 @code{org-log-note-clock-out} and @code{org-log-repeat})
12688 @cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
12689 @cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
12690 @cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
12691 @cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
12692 @cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
12693 @cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
12694 @cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
12695 @cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
12696 @cindex @code{logreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
12697 @cindex @code{lognotereschedule}, STARTUP keyword
12698 @cindex @code{nologreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
12699 @cindex @code{logredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
12700 @cindex @code{lognoteredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
12701 @cindex @code{nologredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
12702 @cindex @code{logrefile}, STARTUP keyword
12703 @cindex @code{lognoterefile}, STARTUP keyword
12704 @cindex @code{nologrefile}, STARTUP keyword
12706 logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
12707 lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
12708 nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
12709 logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
12710 lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
12711 nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
12712 lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
12713 nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
12714 logreschedule @r{record a timestamp when scheduling time changes}
12715 lognotereschedule @r{record a note when scheduling time changes}
12716 nologreschedule @r{do not record when a scheduling date changes}
12717 logredeadline @r{record a timestamp when deadline changes}
12718 lognoteredeadline @r{record a note when deadline changes}
12719 nologredeadline @r{do not record when a deadline date changes}
12720 logrefile @r{record a timestamp when refiling}
12721 lognoterefile @r{record a note when refiling}
12722 nologrefile @r{do not record when refiling}
12724 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
12725 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
12726 Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for
12727 indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
12728 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a
12729 default setting @code{nil} (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
12730 @cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
12731 @cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
12732 @cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
12733 @cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
12735 hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.}
12736 showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline}
12737 indent @r{virtual indentation according to outline level}
12738 noindent @r{no virtual indentation according to outline level}
12739 odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)}
12740 oddeven @r{allow all outline levels}
12742 @vindex org-put-time-stamp-overlays
12743 @vindex org-time-stamp-overlay-formats
12744 To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables
12745 @code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
12746 @code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
12747 @cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
12749 customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
12751 @vindex constants-unit-system
12752 The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
12753 @code{constants-unit-system}).
12754 @cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
12755 @cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
12757 constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
12758 constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
12760 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
12761 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
12762 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
12763 To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
12764 corresponding variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline},
12765 @code{org-footnote-auto-label}, and @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.
12766 @cindex @code{fninline}, STARTUP keyword
12767 @cindex @code{nofninline}, STARTUP keyword
12768 @cindex @code{fnlocal}, STARTUP keyword
12769 @cindex @code{fnprompt}, STARTUP keyword
12770 @cindex @code{fnauto}, STARTUP keyword
12771 @cindex @code{fnconfirm}, STARTUP keyword
12772 @cindex @code{fnplain}, STARTUP keyword
12773 @cindex @code{fnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
12774 @cindex @code{nofnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
12776 fninline @r{define footnotes inline}
12777 fnnoinline @r{define footnotes in separate section}
12778 fnlocal @r{define footnotes near first reference, but not inline}
12779 fnprompt @r{prompt for footnote labels}
12780 fnauto @r{create [fn:1]-like labels automatically (default)}
12781 fnconfirm @r{offer automatic label for editing or confirmation}
12782 fnplain @r{create [1]-like labels automatically}
12783 fnadjust @r{automatically renumber and sort footnotes}
12784 nofnadjust @r{do not renumber and sort automatically}
12786 @cindex org-hide-block-startup
12787 To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding variable is
12788 @code{org-hide-block-startup}.
12789 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
12790 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
12792 hideblocks @r{Hide all begin/end blocks on startup}
12793 nohideblocks @r{Do not hide blocks on startup}
12795 @cindex org-pretty-entities
12796 The the display of entities as UTF8 characters is governed by the variable
12797 @code{org-pretty-entities} and the keywords
12798 @cindex @code{entitiespretty}, STARTUP keyword
12799 @cindex @code{entitiesplain}, STARTUP keyword
12801 entitiespretty @r{Show entities as UTF8 characters where possible}
12802 entitiesplain @r{Leave entities plain}
12804 @item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
12805 @vindex org-tag-alist
12806 These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in
12807 this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection}
12808 keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
12810 This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line.
12811 @item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+DATE:,
12812 @itemx #+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:, #+XSLT:,
12813 @itemx #+DESCRIPTION:, #+KEYWORDS:,
12814 @itemx #+LATEX_HEADER:, #+STYLE:, #+LINK_UP:, #+LINK_HOME:,
12815 @itemx #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS:
12816 These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
12817 @ref{Export options}.
12818 @item #+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
12819 @vindex org-todo-keywords
12820 These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
12821 current file. The corresponding variable is @code{org-todo-keywords}.
12824 @node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous
12825 @section The very busy C-c C-c key
12827 @cindex C-c C-c, overview
12829 The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in Org, which are all
12830 mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of
12831 this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many
12832 other circumstances it means something like @emph{``Hey Org, look
12833 here and update according to what you see here''}. Here is a summary of
12834 what this means in different contexts.
12838 If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
12839 tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
12841 If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this
12842 triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
12845 If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
12846 works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
12848 If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
12851 If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file it.
12852 With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the
12855 If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
12856 corresponding links in this buffer.
12858 If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property
12859 drawer, offer property commands.
12861 If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
12862 definition, and vice versa.
12864 If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it.
12866 If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
12869 If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
12872 If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamic block, the
12876 @node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous
12877 @section A cleaner outline view
12878 @cindex hiding leading stars
12879 @cindex dynamic indentation
12880 @cindex odd-levels-only outlines
12881 @cindex clean outline view
12883 Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines start with a
12884 potentially large number of stars, and that text below the headlines is not
12885 indented. While this is no problem when writing a @emph{book-like} document
12886 where the outline headings are really section headings, in a more
12887 @emph{list-oriented} outline, indented structure is a lot cleaner:
12891 * Top level headline | * Top level headline
12892 ** Second level | * Second level
12893 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
12894 some text | some text
12895 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
12896 more text | more text
12897 * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
12903 If you are using at least Emacs 23.2@footnote{Emacs 23.1 can actually crash
12904 with @code{org-indent-mode}} and version 6.29 of Org, this kind of view can
12905 be achieved dynamically at display time using @code{org-indent-mode}. In
12906 this minor mode, all lines are prefixed for display with the necessary amount
12907 of space@footnote{@code{org-indent-mode} also sets the @code{wrap-prefix}
12908 property, such that @code{visual-line-mode} (or purely setting
12909 @code{word-wrap}) wraps long lines (including headlines) correctly indented.
12910 }. Also headlines are prefixed with additional stars, so that the amount of
12911 indentation shifts by two@footnote{See the variable
12912 @code{org-indent-indentation-per-level}.} spaces per level. All headline
12913 stars but the last one are made invisible using the @code{org-hide}
12914 face@footnote{Turning on @code{org-indent-mode} sets
12915 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} to @code{t} and @code{org-adapt-indentation} to
12916 @code{nil}.} - see below under @samp{2.} for more information on how this
12917 works. You can turn on @code{org-indent-mode} for all files by customizing
12918 the variable @code{org-startup-indented}, or you can turn it on for
12919 individual files using
12925 If you want a similar effect in earlier version of Emacs and/or Org, or if
12926 you want the indentation to be hard space characters so that the plain text
12927 file looks as similar as possible to the Emacs display, Org supports you in
12932 @emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
12933 You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary line up
12934 with the headline, like
12938 more text, now indented
12941 @vindex org-adapt-indentation
12942 Org supports this with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure
12943 editing@footnote{See also the variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.},
12944 preserving or adapting the indentation as appropriate.
12947 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
12948 @emph{Hiding leading stars}@* You can modify the display in such a way that
12949 all leading stars become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure
12950 the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars} or change this on a per-file basis
12954 #+STARTUP: hidestars
12955 #+STARTUP: showstars
12958 With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
12962 * Top level headline
12970 @vindex org-hide @r{(face)}
12971 The leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they are only
12972 fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the background color as
12973 font color. If you are not using either white or black background, you may
12974 have to customize this face to get the wanted effect. Another possibility is
12975 to set this font such that the extra stars are @i{almost} invisible, for
12976 example using the color @code{grey90} on a white background.
12979 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
12980 Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only odd
12981 levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one outline level
12982 to the next@footnote{When you need to specify a level for a property search
12983 or refile targets, @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars, etc@.}. In this
12984 way we get the outline view shown at the beginning of this section. In order
12985 to make the structure editing and export commands handle this convention
12986 correctly, configure the variable @code{org-odd-levels-only}, or set this on
12987 a per-file basis with one of the following lines:
12994 You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
12995 double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels
12996 RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x
12997 org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
13000 @node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous
13001 @section Using Org on a tty
13002 @cindex tty key bindings
13004 Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default many of
13005 Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not
13006 accessible on a tty, such as the cursor keys (@key{left}, @key{right},
13007 @key{up}, @key{down}), @key{TAB} and @key{RET}, in particular when used
13008 together with modifiers like @key{Meta} and/or @key{Shift}. To access
13009 these commands on a tty when special keys are unavailable, the following
13010 alternative bindings can be used. The tty bindings below will likely be
13011 more cumbersome; you may find for some of the bindings below that a
13012 customized workaround suits you better. For example, changing a timestamp
13013 is really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, whereas on a
13014 tty you would rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp.
13016 @multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.1 0.2
13017 @item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Speed key} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
13018 @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C} @tab
13019 @item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
13020 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab @kbd{L} @tab
13021 @item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x r} @tab @kbd{r} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
13022 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab @kbd{R} @tab
13023 @item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
13024 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab @kbd{U} @tab
13025 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
13026 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab @kbd{D} @tab
13027 @item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13028 @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
13029 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13030 @item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13031 @item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13032 @item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13033 @item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13034 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13035 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13039 @node Interaction, , TTY keys, Miscellaneous
13040 @section Interaction with other packages
13041 @cindex packages, interaction with other
13042 Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways
13043 with other code out there.
13046 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
13047 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
13050 @node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction
13051 @subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
13054 @cindex @file{calc.el}
13055 @cindex Gillespie, Dave
13056 @item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
13057 Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
13058 functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org
13059 checks for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
13060 @code{calc-eval} which will have been autoloaded during setup if Calc has
13061 been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the Emacs
13062 distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two
13063 packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode,
13064 , Embedded Mode, Calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
13065 @item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
13066 @cindex @file{constants.el}
13067 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
13068 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
13069 In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use
13070 names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
13071 constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install
13072 the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants
13073 and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for
13074 @samp{Mega}, etc@. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available
13075 at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks for
13076 the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your
13077 setup. See the installation instructions in the file
13078 @file{constants.el}.
13079 @item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
13080 @cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
13081 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
13082 Org-mode can make use of the CDLa@TeX{} package to efficiently enter
13083 La@TeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}.
13084 @item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
13085 @cindex @file{imenu.el}
13086 Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org-mode
13087 supports Imenu---all you need to do to get the index is the following:
13089 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
13090 (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
13092 @vindex org-imenu-depth
13093 By default the index is two levels deep---you can modify the depth using
13094 the option @code{org-imenu-depth}.
13095 @item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley
13096 @cindex @file{remember.el}
13097 @cindex Wiegley, John
13098 Org used to use this package for capture, but no longer does.
13099 @item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
13100 @cindex @file{speedbar.el}
13101 @cindex Ludlam, Eric M.
13102 Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying files and
13103 index items in files. Org-mode supports Speedbar and allows you to
13104 drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It also allows you to
13105 restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file or a subtree by using
13106 the command @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame.
13107 @cindex @file{table.el}
13108 @item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
13110 @cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
13111 @cindex @file{table.el}
13112 @cindex Ota, Takaaki
13114 Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and row-spanning,
13115 and alignment can be created using the Emacs table package by Takaaki Ota
13116 (@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table}, and also part of Emacs 22).
13117 Org-mode will recognize these tables and export them properly. Because of
13118 interference with other Org-mode functionality, you unfortunately cannot edit
13119 these tables directly in the buffer. Instead, you need to use the command
13120 @kbd{C-c '} to edit them, similar to source code snippets.
13125 Edit a @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a table.el table.
13129 Insert a @file{table.el} table. If there is already a table at point, this
13130 command converts it between the @file{table.el} format and the Org-mode
13131 format. See the documentation string of the command
13132 @code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is
13135 @file{table.el} is part of Emacs since Emacs 22.
13136 @item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
13137 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
13138 @cindex Baur, Steven L.
13139 Org-mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package.
13140 However, Org-mode also has its own footnote support (@pxref{Footnotes}),
13141 which makes using @file{footnote.el} unnecessary.
13144 @node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction
13145 @subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org-mode
13149 @cindex @code{shift-selection-mode}
13150 @vindex org-support-shift-select
13151 In Emacs 23, @code{shift-selection-mode} is on by default, meaning that
13152 cursor motions combined with the shift key should start or enlarge regions.
13153 This conflicts with the use of @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands in Org to change
13154 timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types if the cursor is
13155 at such a location. By default, @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands outside
13156 special contexts don't do anything, but you can customize the variable
13157 @code{org-support-shift-select}. Org-mode then tries to accommodate shift
13158 selection by (i) using it outside of the special contexts where special
13159 commands apply, and by (ii) extending an existing active region even if the
13160 cursor moves across a special context.
13162 @item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
13163 @cindex @file{CUA.el}
13164 @cindex Storm, Kim. F.
13165 @vindex org-replace-disputed-keys
13166 Key bindings in Org conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by CUA mode
13167 (as well as @code{pc-select-mode} and @code{s-region-mode}) to select and extend the
13168 region. In fact, Emacs 23 has this built-in in the form of
13169 @code{shift-selection-mode}, see previous paragraph. If you are using Emacs
13170 23, you probably don't want to use another package for this purpose. However,
13171 if you prefer to leave these keys to a different package while working in
13172 Org-mode, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When set,
13173 Org will move the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda
13174 buffer (but not during date selection).
13177 S-UP -> M-p S-DOWN -> M-n
13178 S-LEFT -> M-- S-RIGHT -> M-+
13179 C-S-LEFT -> M-S-- C-S-RIGHT -> M-S-+
13182 @vindex org-disputed-keys
13183 Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want
13184 to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
13185 @code{org-disputed-keys}.
13187 @item @file{yasnippet.el}
13188 @cindex @file{yasnippet.el}
13189 The way Org-mode binds the TAB key (binding to @code{[tab]} instead of
13190 @code{"\t"}) overrules yasnippets' access to this key. The following code
13191 fixed this problem:
13194 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
13196 (org-set-local 'yas/trigger-key [tab])
13197 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-group)))
13200 @item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
13201 @cindex @file{windmove.el}
13202 This package also uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
13203 in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. If you want make
13204 the windmove function active in locations where Org-mode does not have
13205 special functionality on @kbd{S-@key{cursor}}, add this to your
13209 ;; Make windmove work in org-mode:
13210 (add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up)
13211 (add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left)
13212 (add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down)
13213 (add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right)
13216 @item @file{viper.el} by Michael Kifer
13217 @cindex @file{viper.el}
13219 Viper uses @kbd{C-c /} and therefore makes this key not access the
13220 corresponding Org-mode command @code{org-sparse-tree}. You need to find
13221 another key for this command, or override the key in
13222 @code{viper-vi-global-user-map} with
13225 (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)
13231 @node Hacking, MobileOrg, Miscellaneous, Top
13235 This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of
13239 * Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
13240 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
13241 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
13242 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
13243 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for La@TeX{} and other programs
13244 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
13245 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
13246 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
13247 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
13248 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
13251 @node Hooks, Add-on packages, Hacking, Hacking
13255 Org has a large number of hook variables that can be used to add
13256 functionality. This appendix about hacking is going to illustrate the
13257 use of some of them. A complete list of all hooks with documentation is
13258 maintained by the Worg project and can be found at
13259 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-configs/org-hooks.php}.
13261 @node Add-on packages, Adding hyperlink types, Hooks, Hacking
13262 @section Add-on packages
13263 @cindex add-on packages
13265 A large number of add-on packages have been written by various authors.
13266 These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as contributed
13267 packages with the separate release available at the Org-mode home page at
13268 @uref{http://orgmode.org}. The list of contributed packages, along with
13269 documentation about each package, is maintained by the Worg project at
13270 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/}.
13274 @node Adding hyperlink types, Context-sensitive commands, Add-on packages, Hacking
13275 @section Adding hyperlink types
13276 @cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
13278 Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in
13279 (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, Org
13280 provides an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file,
13281 @file{org-man.el}, that will add support for creating links like
13282 @samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show Unix manual pages inside
13286 ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
13290 (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
13291 (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
13293 (defcustom org-man-command 'man
13294 "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
13296 :type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
13298 (defun org-man-open (path)
13299 "Visit the manpage on PATH.
13300 PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
13301 (funcall org-man-command path))
13303 (defun org-man-store-link ()
13304 "Store a link to a manpage."
13305 (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
13306 ;; This is a man page, we do make this link
13307 (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
13308 (link (concat "man:" page))
13309 (description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
13310 (org-store-link-props
13313 :description description))))
13315 (defun org-man-get-page-name ()
13316 "Extract the page name from the buffer name."
13317 ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
13318 (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
13319 (match-string 1 (buffer-name))
13320 (error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
13324 ;;; org-man.el ends here
13328 You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with
13335 Let's go through the file and see what it does.
13338 It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been
13341 The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type
13342 with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function
13343 that will be called to follow such a link.
13345 @vindex org-store-link-functions
13346 The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in
13347 order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a
13348 buffer displaying a man page.
13351 The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
13352 First there is a customization variable that determines which Emacs
13353 command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
13354 @code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is
13355 defined. It gets the link path as an argument---in this case the link
13356 path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the
13357 value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
13359 Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try
13360 to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, this function will be called to
13361 try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
13362 create the link for this buffer type; we do this by checking the value
13363 of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and
13364 return the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the
13365 manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
13366 @samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props}
13367 and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you
13368 can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for
13369 the link description when the link is later inserted into an Org
13370 buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
13372 When is makes sense for your new link type, you may also define a function
13373 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g. completion)
13374 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
13375 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
13377 @node Context-sensitive commands, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Adding hyperlink types, Hacking
13378 @section Context-sensitive commands
13379 @cindex context-sensitive commands, hooks
13380 @cindex add-ons, context-sensitive commands
13381 @vindex org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook
13383 Org has several commands that act differently depending on context. The most
13384 important example it the @kbd{C-c C-c} (@pxref{The very busy C-c C-c key}).
13385 Also the @kbd{M-cursor} and @kbd{M-S-cursor} keys have this property.
13387 Add-ons can tap into this functionality by providing a function that detects
13388 special context for that add-on and executes functionality appropriate for
13389 the context. Here is an example from Dan Davison's @file{org-R.el} which
13390 allows you to evaluate commands based on the @file{R} programming language
13391 @footnote{@file{org-R.el} has been replaced by the org-mode functionality
13392 described in @ref{Working With Source Code} and is now obsolete.}. For this
13393 package, special contexts are lines that start with @code{#+R:} or
13397 (defun org-R-apply-maybe ()
13398 "Detect if this is context for org-R and execute R commands."
13399 (if (save-excursion
13400 (beginning-of-line 1)
13401 (looking-at "#\\+RR?:"))
13402 (progn (call-interactively 'org-R-apply)
13403 t) ;; to signal that we took action
13404 nil)) ;; to signal that we did not
13406 (add-hook 'org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook 'org-R-apply-maybe)
13409 The function first checks if the cursor is in such a line. If that is the
13410 case, @code{org-R-apply} is called and the function returns @code{t} to
13411 signal that action was taken, and @kbd{C-c C-c} will stop looking for other
13412 contexts. If the function finds it should do nothing locally, it returns @code{nil} so that other, similar functions can have a try.
13415 @node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Context-sensitive commands, Hacking
13416 @section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
13417 @cindex tables, in other modes
13418 @cindex lists, in other modes
13419 @cindex Orgtbl mode
13421 Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
13422 frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
13423 specific languages, for example La@TeX{}. However, this is extremely
13424 hard to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare,
13425 and would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl-mode table
13428 This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl mode
13429 table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom
13430 function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to
13431 @i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts
13432 the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows
13433 for a very flexible system.
13435 Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists, in Orgstruct mode. You
13436 can use Org's facilities to edit and structure lists by turning
13437 @code{orgstruct-mode} on, then locally exporting such lists in another format
13438 (HTML, La@TeX{} or Texinfo.)
13442 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
13443 * A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
13444 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
13445 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
13448 @node Radio tables, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax
13449 @subsection Radio tables
13450 @cindex radio tables
13452 To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
13453 lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for
13454 Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will insert the translated table
13455 between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example:
13458 /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
13459 /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
13463 Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells
13464 Orgtbl mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For
13468 #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
13472 @code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used
13473 in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function
13474 that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
13475 arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
13476 passed as a property list to the translation function for
13477 interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
13478 acted upon before the translation function is called:
13482 Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate lines for
13485 @item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
13486 List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with
13487 calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well.
13488 Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the
13489 removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been
13490 additional columns.
13494 The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
13495 without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
13496 compilation of a C file or processing of a La@TeX{} file. There are a
13497 number of different solutions:
13501 The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the
13502 language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between
13503 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
13505 Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END}
13506 statement, for example @samp{\bye} in @TeX{} and @samp{\end@{document@}}
13509 You can just comment the table line-by-line whenever you want to process
13510 the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This
13511 only sounds tedious---the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment}
13512 makes this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a
13516 @node A LaTeX example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax
13517 @subsection A La@TeX{} example of radio tables
13518 @cindex La@TeX{}, and Orgtbl mode
13520 The best way to wrap the source table in La@TeX{} is to use the
13521 @code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be
13522 activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document
13523 header. Orgtbl mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By
13524 default this works only for La@TeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the
13525 variable @code{orgtbl-radio-tables} to install templates for other
13526 modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}. You will
13527 be prompted for a table name, let's say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You
13528 will then get the following template:
13530 @cindex #+ORGTBL, SEND
13532 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13533 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13535 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
13541 @vindex La@TeX{}-verbatim-environments
13542 The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
13543 @code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into La@TeX{} and to put it
13544 into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now
13545 fill in the table, feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If
13546 the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters,
13547 this may cause problems with font-lock in La@TeX{} mode. As shown in the
13548 example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
13549 @code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar
13550 expressions. If you are using AUC@TeX{} with the font-latex library, a
13551 much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the
13552 variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
13555 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13556 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13558 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
13559 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
13560 |-------+------+---------+---------|
13561 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
13562 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
13563 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
13564 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
13565 % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
13570 When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted
13571 table inserted between the two marker lines.
13573 Now let's assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you
13574 want to control how columns are aligned, etc@. In this case we make sure
13575 that the table translator skips the first 2 lines of the source
13576 table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e. to not produce
13577 header and footer commands of the target table:
13580 \begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
13581 Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
13582 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13583 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13587 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
13588 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
13589 |-------+------+---------+---------|
13590 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
13591 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
13592 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
13593 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
13597 The La@TeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
13598 Orgtbl mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table
13599 and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it
13600 interprets the following parameters (see also @pxref{Translator functions}):
13603 @item :splice nil/t
13604 When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
13605 tabular environment. Default is nil.
13608 A format to be used to wrap each field, it should contain @code{%s} for the
13609 original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars,
13610 you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with
13611 column numbers and formats. for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
13612 A function of one argument can be used in place of the strings; the
13613 function must return a formatted string.
13616 Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should
13617 have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example
13618 @code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This
13619 may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
13620 @code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
13621 @code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be
13622 applied. Similar to @code{fmt}, functions of two arguments can be
13623 supplied instead of strings.
13626 @node Translator functions, Radio lists, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax
13627 @subsection Translator functions
13628 @cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
13629 @cindex translator function
13631 Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
13632 (comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values)
13633 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}.
13634 Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The HTML translator uses the same
13635 code that produces tables during HTML export.}, these all use a generic
13636 translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex}
13637 itself is a very short function that computes the column definitions for the
13638 @code{tabular} environment, defines a few field and line separators and then
13639 hands processing over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
13643 (defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
13644 "Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
13645 (let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
13646 org-table-last-alignment ""))
13649 :tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}")
13650 :tend "\\end@{tabular@}"
13651 :lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
13652 :efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
13653 (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
13657 As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
13658 @var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
13659 (variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e. the
13660 ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you
13661 would like to use the La@TeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to
13662 be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just
13663 overrule the default with
13666 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
13669 For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in
13670 analogy with the La@TeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function
13671 directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started
13672 with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are
13673 started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!}, and where the field
13674 separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on
13678 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
13679 :lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
13683 Please check the documentation string of the function
13684 @code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by
13685 that function, and remember that you can pass each of them into
13686 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
13687 using the generic function.
13689 Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated
13690 things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes
13691 two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each
13692 line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second
13693 argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the
13694 @samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string
13695 containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful
13696 translator, please post it on @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that
13697 others can benefit from your work.
13699 @node Radio lists, , Translator functions, Tables in arbitrary syntax
13700 @subsection Radio lists
13701 @cindex radio lists
13702 @cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
13704 Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way than sending and
13705 receiving radio tables (@pxref{Radio tables}). As for radio tables, you can
13706 insert radio lists templates in HTML, La@TeX{} and Texinfo modes by calling
13707 @code{org-list-insert-radio-list}.
13709 Here are the differences with radio tables:
13713 Orgstruct mode must be active.
13715 Use the @code{ORGLST} keyword instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
13717 The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
13720 @kbd{C-c C-c} will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
13723 Here is a La@TeX{} example. Let's say that you have this in your
13728 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
13729 % END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
13731 #+ORGLST: SEND to-buy org-list-to-latex
13740 Pressing `C-c C-c' on @code{a new house} and will insert the converted
13741 La@TeX{} list between the two marker lines.
13743 @node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking
13744 @section Dynamic blocks
13745 @cindex dynamic blocks
13747 Org documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are
13748 specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function.
13749 A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the
13750 command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
13752 Dynamic block are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name
13753 to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing
13754 the content of the block.
13756 #+BEGIN:dynamic block
13758 #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
13763 Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
13766 @kindex C-c C-x C-u
13768 Update dynamic block at point.
13769 @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u
13770 @item C-u C-c C-x C-u
13771 Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
13774 Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and
13775 END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
13776 writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
13777 to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
13778 extra parameter @code{:content}.
13780 For a block with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is
13781 @code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list
13782 with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example
13783 of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last
13787 #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
13793 The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
13796 (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
13797 (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
13798 (insert "Last block update at: "
13799 (format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
13802 If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date,
13803 you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for
13804 example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is
13805 written in a way such that it does nothing in buffers that are not in
13808 @node Special agenda views, Extracting agenda information, Dynamic blocks, Hacking
13809 @section Special agenda views
13810 @cindex agenda views, user-defined
13812 Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the selection
13813 made by these agenda views: @code{todo}, @code{alltodo}, @code{tags}, @code{tags-todo},
13814 @code{tags-tree}. You may specify a function that is used at each match to verify
13815 if the match should indeed be part of the agenda view, and if not, how
13816 much should be skipped.
13818 Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING
13819 tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have
13820 marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO keyword
13821 PROJECT. In this case you would run a TODO search for the keyword
13822 PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in
13823 the subtree belonging to the project line.
13825 To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for
13826 the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to
13827 indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
13828 tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
13829 search should continue from there.
13832 (defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
13833 "Skip trees that are not waiting"
13834 (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
13835 (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
13836 nil ; tag found, do not skip
13837 subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
13840 Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example
13844 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
13845 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
13846 ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
13847 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
13850 @vindex org-agenda-overriding-header
13851 Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a
13852 meaningful header in the agenda view.
13854 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
13855 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
13856 A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search for
13857 entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all entries with
13858 your custom search function, simply do a search for
13859 @samp{LEVEL>0}@footnote{Note that, when using @code{org-odd-levels-only}, a
13860 level number corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of
13861 stars.}, and then use @code{org-agenda-skip-function} to select the entries
13862 you really want to have.
13864 You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In
13865 particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if}
13866 and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example:
13869 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
13870 Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
13871 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
13872 Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
13873 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
13874 Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
13875 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
13876 Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
13877 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))
13878 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING.
13879 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)
13880 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state.
13881 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)
13882 Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline or scheduled.
13883 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'regexp "regular expression")
13884 Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
13885 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'notregexp "regular expression")
13886 Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
13887 @item '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
13888 Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
13891 Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
13892 like this, even without defining a special function:
13895 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
13896 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
13897 ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
13898 'regexp ":waiting:"))
13899 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
13902 @node Extracting agenda information, Using the property API, Special agenda views, Hacking
13903 @section Extracting agenda information
13904 @cindex agenda, pipe
13905 @cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
13907 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
13908 Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command
13909 line in Emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent
13910 directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
13911 processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
13912 @code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as
13913 ASCII text to STDOUT. The command takes a single string as parameter.
13914 If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands
13915 you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any
13916 key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the
13917 current TODO list, you could use
13920 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
13923 If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a
13924 tags/TODO match string. For example, to print your local shopping list
13925 (all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag
13926 @samp{NewYork}), you could use
13929 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
13930 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
13934 You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
13937 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
13938 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
13939 org-agenda-ndays 30 \
13940 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
13941 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
13946 which will produce a 30-day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
13947 @file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary.
13949 If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you
13950 can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated
13951 list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
13952 contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
13956 category @r{The category of the item}
13957 head @r{The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY}
13958 type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
13959 todo @r{selected in TODO match}
13960 tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
13961 diary @r{imported from diary}
13962 deadline @r{a deadline}
13963 scheduled @r{scheduled}
13964 timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
13965 closed @r{entry was closed on date}
13966 upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
13967 past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
13968 block @r{entry has date block including date}
13969 todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
13970 tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
13971 date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
13972 time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
13973 extra @r{String with extra planning info}
13974 priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
13975 priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
13979 Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
13980 led to the selection of the item.
13982 A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post-processing script.
13983 For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
13984 Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
13989 # define the Emacs command to run
13990 $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
13992 # run it and capture the output
13993 $agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
13995 # loop over all lines
13996 foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
13997 # get the individual values
13998 ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
13999 $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
14000 # process and print
14001 print "[ ] $head\n";
14005 @node Using the property API, Using the mapping API, Extracting agenda information, Hacking
14006 @section Using the property API
14007 @cindex API, for properties
14008 @cindex properties, API
14010 Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
14013 @defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
14014 Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.@*
14015 This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
14016 scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
14017 entry. The return value is an alist, keys may occur multiple times
14018 if the property key was used several times.@*
14019 POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used.
14020 If WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is
14021 `special' or `standard', only get that subclass.
14023 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
14024 @defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
14025 Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM. By default,
14026 this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If INHERIT
14027 is non-nil and the entry does not have the property, then also check
14028 higher levels of the hierarchy. If INHERIT is the symbol
14029 @code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
14030 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects PROPERTY for inheritance.
14033 @defun org-entry-delete pom property
14034 Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM.
14037 @defun org-entry-put pom property value
14038 Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM.
14041 @defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
14042 Get all property keys in the current buffer.
14045 @defun org-insert-property-drawer
14046 Insert a property drawer at point.
14049 @defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
14050 Set PROPERTY at point-or-marker POM to VALUES. VALUES should be a list of
14051 strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as separators.
14054 @defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
14055 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
14056 values and return the values as a list of strings.
14059 @defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
14060 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
14061 values and make sure that VALUE is in this list.
14064 @defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
14065 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
14066 values and make sure that VALUE is @emph{not} in this list.
14069 @defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
14070 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
14071 values and check if VALUE is in this list.
14074 @defopt org-property-allowed-value-functions
14075 Hook for functions supplying allowed values for specific.
14076 The functions must take a single argument, the name of the property, and
14077 return a flat list of allowed values. If @samp{:ETC} is one of
14078 the values, use the values as completion help, but allow also other values
14079 to be entered. The functions must return @code{nil} if they are not
14080 responsible for this property.
14083 @node Using the mapping API, , Using the property API, Hacking
14084 @section Using the mapping API
14085 @cindex API, for mapping
14086 @cindex mapping entries, API
14088 Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying
14089 certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda
14090 views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary
14091 functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API
14094 @defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
14095 Call FUNC at each headline selected by MATCH in SCOPE.
14097 FUNC is a function or a Lisp form. The function will be called without
14098 arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of the headline.
14099 The return values of all calls to the function will be collected and
14100 returned as a list.
14102 The call to FUNC will be wrapped into a save-excursion form, so FUNC
14103 does not need to preserve point. After evaluation, the cursor will be
14104 moved to the end of the line (presumably of the headline of the
14105 processed entry) and search continues from there. Under some
14106 circumstances, this may not produce the wanted results. For example,
14107 if you have removed (e.g. archived) the current (sub)tree it could
14108 mean that the next entry will be skipped entirely. In such cases, you
14109 can specify the position from where search should continue by making
14110 FUNC set the variable `org-map-continue-from' to the desired buffer
14113 MATCH is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda match view.
14114 Only headlines that are matched by this query will be considered during
14115 the iteration. When MATCH is nil or t, all headlines will be
14116 visited by the iteration.
14118 SCOPE determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
14121 nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
14122 tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
14123 file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
14125 @r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
14126 agenda @r{all agenda files}
14127 agenda-with-archives
14128 @r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
14130 @r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
14133 The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping facilities of
14134 the scanner. The following items can be given here:
14136 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
14138 archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
14139 comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
14140 function or Lisp form
14141 @r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
14142 @r{so whenever the function returns t, FUNC}
14143 @r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
14144 @r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
14148 The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything you like.
14149 It can use the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}) to gather more
14150 information about the entry, or in order to change metadata in the entry.
14151 Here are a couple of functions that might be handy:
14153 @defun org-todo &optional arg
14154 Change the TODO state of the entry, see the docstring of the functions for
14155 the many possible values for the argument ARG.
14158 @defun org-priority &optional action
14159 Change the priority of the entry, see the docstring of this function for the
14160 possible values for ACTION.
14163 @defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
14164 Toggle the tag TAG in the current entry. Setting ONOFF to either @code{on}
14165 or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off.
14169 Promote the current entry.
14173 Demote the current entry.
14176 Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current file with
14177 a tag @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with the keyword @code{UPCOMING}.
14178 Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be ignored.
14182 '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
14183 "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
14186 The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
14187 @code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
14190 (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
14193 @node MobileOrg, History and Acknowledgments, Hacking, Top
14194 @appendix MobileOrg
14198 @uref{http://mobileorg.ncogni.to/, MobileOrg} is an application for the
14199 @i{iPhone/iPod Touch} series of devices, developed by Richard Moreland.
14200 @i{MobileOrg} offers offline viewing and capture support for an Org-mode
14201 system rooted on a ``real'' computer. It does also allow you to record
14202 changes to existing entries. Android users should check out
14203 @uref{http://wiki.github.com/matburt/mobileorg-android/, MobileOrg Android}
14206 This appendix describes the support Org has for creating agenda views in a
14207 format that can be displayed by @i{MobileOrg}, and for integrating notes
14208 captured and changes made by @i{MobileOrg} into the main system.
14210 For changing tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, you should have set up the
14211 customization variables @code{org-todo-keywords} and @code{org-tags-alist} to
14212 cover all important tags and TODO keywords, even if individual files use only
14213 part of these. MobileOrg will also offer you states and tags set up with
14214 in-buffer settings, but it will understand the logistics of TODO state
14215 @i{sets} (@pxref{Per-file keywords}) and @i{mutually exclusive} tags
14216 (@pxref{Setting tags}) only for those set in these variables.
14219 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
14220 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
14221 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
14224 @node Setting up the staging area, Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg, MobileOrg
14225 @section Setting up the staging area
14227 MobileOrg needs to interact with Emacs through directory on a
14228 server@footnote{If you are using a public server, you might prefer to encrypt
14229 the files on the server. This can be done with Org-mode 6.35 and, hopefully,
14230 with MobileOrg 1.4 (please check before trying to use this). On the Emacs
14231 side, configure the variables @code{org-mobile-use-encryption} and
14232 @code{org-mobile-encryption-password}.}. The easiest way to create that
14233 directory is to use a free @uref{http://dropbox.com,Dropbox.com}
14234 account@footnote{If you cannot use Dropbox, or if your version of MobileOrg
14235 does not support it, you can use a webdav server. For more information,
14236 check out the the documentation of MobileOrg and also this
14237 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.php#mobileorg_webdav, FAQ entry}.}.
14238 When MobileOrg first connects to your Dropbox, it will create a directory
14239 @i{MobileOrg} inside the Dropbox. After the directory has been created, tell
14243 (setq org-mobile-directory "~/Dropbox/MobileOrg")
14246 Org-mode has commands to put files for @i{MobileOrg} into that directory,
14247 and to read captured notes from there.
14249 @node Pushing to MobileOrg, Pulling from MobileOrg, Setting up the staging area, MobileOrg
14250 @section Pushing to MobileOrg
14252 This operation copies all files currently listed in @code{org-mobile-files}
14253 to the directory @code{org-mobile-directory}. By default this list contains
14254 all agenda files (as listed in @code{org-agenda-files}), but additional files
14255 can be included by customizing @code{org-mobiles-files}. File names will be
14256 staged with path relative to @code{org-directory}, so all files should be
14257 inside this directory. The push operation also creates a special Org file
14258 @file{agendas.org} with all custom agenda view defined by the
14259 user@footnote{While creating the agendas, Org-mode will force (see the
14260 variable @code{org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items}) ID properties on all
14261 referenced entries, so that these entries can be uniquely
14262 identified if @i{MobileOrg} flags them for further action.}. Finally, Org
14263 writes the file @file{index.org}, containing links to all other files.
14264 @i{MobileOrg} first reads this file from the server, and then downloads all
14265 agendas and Org files listed in it. To speed up the download, MobileOrg will
14266 only read files whose checksums@footnote{stored automatically in the file
14267 @file{checksums.dat}} have changed.
14269 @node Pulling from MobileOrg, , Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg
14270 @section Pulling from MobileOrg
14272 When @i{MobileOrg} synchronizes with the server, it not only pulls the Org
14273 files for viewing. It also appends captured entries and pointers to flagged
14274 and changed entries to the file @file{mobileorg.org} on the server. Org has
14275 a @emph{pull} operation that integrates this information into an inbox file
14276 and operates on the pointers to flagged entries. Here is how it works:
14280 Org moves all entries found in
14281 @file{mobileorg.org}@footnote{@file{mobileorg.org} will be empty after this
14282 operation.} and appends them to the file pointed to by the variable
14283 @code{org-mobile-inbox-for-pull}. Each captured entry and each editing event
14284 will be a top-level entry in the inbox file.
14286 After moving the entries, Org will attempt to implement the changes made in
14287 @i{MobileOrg}. Some changes are applied directly and without user
14288 interaction. Examples are all changes to tags, TODO state, headline and body
14289 text that can be cleanly applied. Entries that have been flagged for further
14290 action will receive a tag @code{:FLAGGED:}, so that they can be easily found
14291 again. When there is a problem finding an entry or applying the change, the
14292 pointer entry will remain in the inbox and will be marked with an error
14293 message. You need to later resolve these issues by hand.
14295 Org will then generate an agenda view with all flagged entries. The user
14296 should then go through these entries and do whatever actions are necessary.
14297 If a note has been stored while flagging an entry in @i{MobileOrg}, that note
14298 will be displayed in the echo area when the cursor is on the corresponding
14303 Pressing @kbd{?} in that special agenda will display the full flagging note in
14304 another window and also push it onto the kill ring. So you could use @kbd{?
14305 z C-y C-c C-c} to store that flagging note as a normal note in the entry.
14306 Pressing @kbd{?} twice in succession will offer to remove the
14307 @code{:FLAGGED:} tag along with the recorded flagging note (which is stored
14308 in a property). In this way you indicate, that the intended processing for
14309 this flagged entry is finished.
14314 If you are not able to process all flagged entries directly, you can always
14315 return to this agenda view using @kbd{C-c a ?}. Note, however, that there is
14316 a subtle difference. The view created automatically by @kbd{M-x
14317 org-mobile-pull @key{RET}} is guaranteed to search all files that have been
14318 addressed by the last pull. This might include a file that is not currently
14319 in your list of agenda files. If you later use @kbd{C-c a ?} to regenerate
14320 the view, only the current agenda files will be searched.
14322 @node History and Acknowledgments, Main Index, MobileOrg, Top
14323 @appendix History and acknowledgments
14324 @cindex acknowledgments
14328 Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of the Emacs
14329 Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and projects, and using
14330 Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, having to remember eleven
14331 different commands with two or three keys per command, only to hide and show
14332 parts of the outline tree, that seemed entirely unacceptable to me. Also,
14333 when using outlines to take notes, I constantly wanted to restructure the
14334 tree, organizing it parallel to my thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility
14335 cycling} and @emph{structure editing} were originally implemented in the
14336 package @file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general
14337 @file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project planning,
14338 the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{timestamps}, and
14339 @emph{table support}. These areas highlighted the two main goals that Org
14340 still has today: to be a new, outline-based, plain text mode with innovative
14341 and intuitive editing features, and to incorporate project planning
14342 functionality directly into a notes file.
14344 Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to
14345 @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
14346 reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
14347 Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
14348 trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
14349 in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
14350 complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
14353 Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order:
14356 @item Bastien Guerry
14357 Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of them
14358 integrated into the core by now), including the LaTeX exporter and the plain
14359 list parser. His support during the early days, when he basically acted as
14360 co-maintainer, was central to the success of this project. Bastien also
14361 invented Worg, helped establishing the Web presence of Org, and sponsors
14362 hosting costs for the orgmode.org website.
14363 @item Eric Schulte and Dan Davison
14364 Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org-babel system, which turns
14365 Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating code and doing literate
14366 programming and reproducible research.
14368 John has also contributed a number of great ideas and patches
14369 directly to Org, including the attachment system (@file{org-attach.el}),
14370 integration with Apple Mail (@file{org-mac-message.el}), hierarchical
14371 dependencies of TODO items, habit tracking (@file{org-habits.el}), and
14372 encryption (@file{org-crypt.el}). Also, the capture system is really an
14373 extended copy of his great @file{remember.el}.
14374 @item Sebastian Rose
14375 Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the pitiful work
14376 of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this part of Org onto a much
14377 higher level. He also wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
14378 webpages derived from Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with
14379 single-key navigation.
14382 @noindent OK, now to the full list of contributions! Again, please let me
14383 know what I am missing here!
14388 @i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
14390 @i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
14392 @i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
14395 @i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding timestamps.
14397 @i{Jan Böcker} wrote @file{org-docview.el}.
14399 @i{Brad Bozarth} showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org-mode files.
14401 @i{Tom Breton} wrote @file{org-choose.el}.
14403 @i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
14404 for Remember, which are now templates for capture.
14406 @i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
14409 @i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for Lisp forms into table
14410 calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
14411 @file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
14413 @i{Sacha Chua} suggested copying some linking code from Planner.
14415 @i{Baoqiu Cui} contributed the DocBook exporter.
14417 @i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
14418 came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
14421 @i{Nick Dokos} tracked down several nasty bugs.
14423 @i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
14424 inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
14425 asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
14427 @i{Thomas S. Dye} contributed documentation on Worg and helped integrating
14428 the Org-Babel documentation into the manual.
14430 @i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format,
14431 patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and inspired the agenda.
14433 @i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
14436 @i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
14438 @i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
14440 @i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
14441 around a match in a hidden outline tree.
14443 @i{Raimar Finken} wrote @file{org-git-line.el}.
14445 @i{Mikael Fornius} works as a mailing list moderator.
14447 @i{Austin Frank} works as a mailing list moderator.
14449 @i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
14451 @i{Nicolas Goaziou} rewrote much of the plain list code.
14453 @i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
14455 @i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
14456 task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
14457 been critical when we started to adopt the Git version control system.
14459 @i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixes and
14462 @i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
14464 @i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
14465 folded entries, and column view for properties.
14467 @i{Matt Jones} wrote @i{MobileOrg Android}.
14469 @i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
14471 @i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded La@TeX{} and tested it. He also
14472 provided frequent feedback and some patches.
14474 @i{Matt Lundin} has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named
14475 invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
14477 @i{David Maus} wrote @file{org-atom.el}, maintains the issues file for Org,
14478 and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent replies,
14479 small fixes and patches.
14481 @i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
14483 @i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling.
14485 @i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
14488 @i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
14491 @i{Richard Moreland} wrote @i{MobileOrg} for the iPhone.
14493 @i{Rick Moynihan} proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file
14494 and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
14496 @i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms.
14498 @i{Greg Newman} refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form.
14500 @i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
14501 file links, and TAGS.
14503 @i{Osamu Okano} wrote @file{orgcard2ref.pl}, a perl program to create a text
14504 version of the reference card.
14506 @i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
14509 @i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
14511 @i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
14512 links, among other things.
14514 @i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
14515 provided frequent feedback.
14517 @i{Martin Pohlack} provided the code snippet to bundle character insertion
14518 into bundles of 20 for undo.
14520 @i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
14522 @i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
14525 @i{Paul Rivier} provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. He
14526 also acted as mailing list moderator for some time.
14528 @i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
14530 @i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
14531 conflict with @file{allout.el}.
14533 @i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl tables with
14536 @i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
14537 of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
14539 @i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
14542 @i{Paul Sexton} wrote @file{org-ctags.el}.
14544 Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
14545 @file{organizer-mode.el}.
14547 @i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
14548 examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
14550 @i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
14551 now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
14553 @i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
14556 @i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
14558 @i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
14559 tweaks and features.
14561 @i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
14562 extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
14564 @i{Ulf Stegemann} created the table to translate special symbols to HTML,
14565 LaTeX, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII.
14567 @i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
14568 with links transformation to Org syntax.
14570 @i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
14571 chapter about publishing.
14573 @i{Stefan Vollmar} organized a video-recorded talk at the
14574 Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation of a
14575 concept index for HTML export.
14577 @i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
14580 @i{Samuel Wales} has provided important feedback and bug reports.
14582 @i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
14585 @i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
14588 @i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
14591 @i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
14594 @i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
14595 and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
14599 @node Main Index, Key Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top
14600 @unnumbered Concept index
14604 @node Key Index, Command and Function Index, Main Index, Top
14605 @unnumbered Key index
14609 @node Command and Function Index, Variable Index, Key Index, Top
14610 @unnumbered Command and function index
14614 @node Variable Index, , Command and Function Index, Top
14615 @unnumbered Variable index
14617 This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that are
14618 mentioned in the manual. For a more complete list, use @kbd{M-x
14619 org-customize @key{RET}} and then click yourself through the tree.
14626 arch-tag: 7893d1Fe-cc57-4d13-b5e5-f494a1CBC7ac
14629 @c Local variables:
14631 @c indent-tabs-mode: nil
14635 @c LocalWords: webdavhost pre